9075 lines
		
	
	
		
			304 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C++
		
	
	
	
			
		
		
	
	
			9075 lines
		
	
	
		
			304 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C++
		
	
	
	
| //===- CIndex.cpp - Clang-C Source Indexing Library -----------------------===//
 | |
| //
 | |
| // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
 | |
| // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
 | |
| // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
 | |
| //
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| //
 | |
| // This file implements the main API hooks in the Clang-C Source Indexing
 | |
| // library.
 | |
| //
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| #include "CIndexDiagnostic.h"
 | |
| #include "CIndexer.h"
 | |
| #include "CLog.h"
 | |
| #include "CXCursor.h"
 | |
| #include "CXSourceLocation.h"
 | |
| #include "CXString.h"
 | |
| #include "CXTranslationUnit.h"
 | |
| #include "CXType.h"
 | |
| #include "CursorVisitor.h"
 | |
| #include "clang-c/FatalErrorHandler.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/AST/OpenMPClause.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/AST/StmtVisitor.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticCategories.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticIDs.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/Stack.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/Version.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Frontend/ASTUnit.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Frontend/CompilerInstance.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Index/CommentToXML.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Lex/PreprocessingRecord.h"
 | |
| #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/ADT/StringSwitch.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/CrashRecoveryContext.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Format.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/ManagedStatic.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/MemoryBuffer.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Program.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/SaveAndRestore.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Signals.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/TargetSelect.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Threading.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/Timer.h"
 | |
| #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
 | |
| #include <mutex>
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if LLVM_ENABLE_THREADS != 0 && defined(__APPLE__)
 | |
| #define USE_DARWIN_THREADS
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef USE_DARWIN_THREADS
 | |
| #include <pthread.h>
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
| using namespace clang;
 | |
| using namespace clang::cxcursor;
 | |
| using namespace clang::cxtu;
 | |
| using namespace clang::cxindex;
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTranslationUnit cxtu::MakeCXTranslationUnit(CIndexer *CIdx,
 | |
|                                               std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> AU) {
 | |
|   if (!AU)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   assert(CIdx);
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit D = new CXTranslationUnitImpl();
 | |
|   D->CIdx = CIdx;
 | |
|   D->TheASTUnit = AU.release();
 | |
|   D->StringPool = new cxstring::CXStringPool();
 | |
|   D->Diagnostics = nullptr;
 | |
|   D->OverridenCursorsPool = createOverridenCXCursorsPool();
 | |
|   D->CommentToXML = nullptr;
 | |
|   D->ParsingOptions = 0;
 | |
|   D->Arguments = {};
 | |
|   return D;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool cxtu::isASTReadError(ASTUnit *AU) {
 | |
|   for (ASTUnit::stored_diag_iterator D = AU->stored_diag_begin(),
 | |
|                                      DEnd = AU->stored_diag_end();
 | |
|        D != DEnd; ++D) {
 | |
|     if (D->getLevel() >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error &&
 | |
|         DiagnosticIDs::getCategoryNumberForDiag(D->getID()) ==
 | |
|             diag::DiagCat_AST_Deserialization_Issue)
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| cxtu::CXTUOwner::~CXTUOwner() {
 | |
|   if (TU)
 | |
|     clang_disposeTranslationUnit(TU);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Compare two source ranges to determine their relative position in
 | |
| /// the translation unit.
 | |
| static RangeComparisonResult RangeCompare(SourceManager &SM,
 | |
|                                           SourceRange R1,
 | |
|                                           SourceRange R2) {
 | |
|   assert(R1.isValid() && "First range is invalid?");
 | |
|   assert(R2.isValid() && "Second range is invalid?");
 | |
|   if (R1.getEnd() != R2.getBegin() &&
 | |
|       SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R1.getEnd(), R2.getBegin()))
 | |
|     return RangeBefore;
 | |
|   if (R2.getEnd() != R1.getBegin() &&
 | |
|       SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R2.getEnd(), R1.getBegin()))
 | |
|     return RangeAfter;
 | |
|   return RangeOverlap;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Determine if a source location falls within, before, or after a
 | |
| ///   a given source range.
 | |
| static RangeComparisonResult LocationCompare(SourceManager &SM,
 | |
|                                              SourceLocation L, SourceRange R) {
 | |
|   assert(R.isValid() && "First range is invalid?");
 | |
|   assert(L.isValid() && "Second range is invalid?");
 | |
|   if (L == R.getBegin() || L == R.getEnd())
 | |
|     return RangeOverlap;
 | |
|   if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L, R.getBegin()))
 | |
|     return RangeBefore;
 | |
|   if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R.getEnd(), L))
 | |
|     return RangeAfter;
 | |
|   return RangeOverlap;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Translate a Clang source range into a CIndex source range.
 | |
| ///
 | |
| /// Clang internally represents ranges where the end location points to the
 | |
| /// start of the token at the end. However, for external clients it is more
 | |
| /// useful to have a CXSourceRange be a proper half-open interval. This routine
 | |
| /// does the appropriate translation.
 | |
| CXSourceRange cxloc::translateSourceRange(const SourceManager &SM,
 | |
|                                           const LangOptions &LangOpts,
 | |
|                                           const CharSourceRange &R) {
 | |
|   // We want the last character in this location, so we will adjust the
 | |
|   // location accordingly.
 | |
|   SourceLocation EndLoc = R.getEnd();
 | |
|   bool IsTokenRange = R.isTokenRange();
 | |
|   if (EndLoc.isValid() && EndLoc.isMacroID() && !SM.isMacroArgExpansion(EndLoc)) {
 | |
|     CharSourceRange Expansion = SM.getExpansionRange(EndLoc);
 | |
|     EndLoc = Expansion.getEnd();
 | |
|     IsTokenRange = Expansion.isTokenRange();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (IsTokenRange && EndLoc.isValid()) {
 | |
|     unsigned Length = Lexer::MeasureTokenLength(SM.getSpellingLoc(EndLoc),
 | |
|                                                 SM, LangOpts);
 | |
|     EndLoc = EndLoc.getLocWithOffset(Length);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXSourceRange Result = {
 | |
|     { &SM, &LangOpts },
 | |
|     R.getBegin().getRawEncoding(),
 | |
|     EndLoc.getRawEncoding()
 | |
|   };
 | |
|   return Result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Cursor visitor.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| static SourceRange getRawCursorExtent(CXCursor C);
 | |
| static SourceRange getFullCursorExtent(CXCursor C, SourceManager &SrcMgr);
 | |
| 
 | |
| RangeComparisonResult CursorVisitor::CompareRegionOfInterest(SourceRange R) {
 | |
|   return RangeCompare(AU->getSourceManager(), R, RegionOfInterest);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Visit the given cursor and, if requested by the visitor,
 | |
| /// its children.
 | |
| ///
 | |
| /// \param Cursor the cursor to visit.
 | |
| ///
 | |
| /// \param CheckedRegionOfInterest if true, then the caller already checked
 | |
| /// that this cursor is within the region of interest.
 | |
| ///
 | |
| /// \returns true if the visitation should be aborted, false if it
 | |
| /// should continue.
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::Visit(CXCursor Cursor, bool CheckedRegionOfInterest) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(Cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(Cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(Cursor);
 | |
|     if (!D) {
 | |
|       assert(0 && "Invalid declaration cursor");
 | |
|       return true; // abort.
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // Ignore implicit declarations, unless it's an objc method because
 | |
|     // currently we should report implicit methods for properties when indexing.
 | |
|     if (D->isImplicit() && !isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If we have a range of interest, and this cursor doesn't intersect with it,
 | |
|   // we're done.
 | |
|   if (RegionOfInterest.isValid() && !CheckedRegionOfInterest) {
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = getRawCursorExtent(Cursor);
 | |
|     if (Range.isInvalid() || CompareRegionOfInterest(Range))
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (Visitor(Cursor, Parent, ClientData)) {
 | |
|   case CXChildVisit_Break:
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case CXChildVisit_Continue:
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case CXChildVisit_Recurse: {
 | |
|     bool ret = VisitChildren(Cursor);
 | |
|     if (PostChildrenVisitor)
 | |
|       if (PostChildrenVisitor(Cursor, ClientData))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|     return ret;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXChildVisitResult!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static bool visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange R,
 | |
|                                              PreprocessingRecord &PPRec,
 | |
|                                              CursorVisitor &Visitor) {
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = Visitor.getASTUnit()->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   FileID FID;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (!Visitor.shouldVisitIncludedEntities()) {
 | |
|     // If the begin/end of the range lie in the same FileID, do the optimization
 | |
|     // where we skip preprocessed entities that do not come from the same FileID.
 | |
|     FID = SM.getFileID(SM.getFileLoc(R.getBegin()));
 | |
|     if (FID != SM.getFileID(SM.getFileLoc(R.getEnd())))
 | |
|       FID = FileID();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const auto &Entities = PPRec.getPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(R);
 | |
|   return Visitor.visitPreprocessedEntities(Entities.begin(), Entities.end(),
 | |
|                                            PPRec, FID);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::visitFileRegion() {
 | |
|   if (RegionOfInterest.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned>
 | |
|     Begin = SM.getDecomposedLoc(SM.getFileLoc(RegionOfInterest.getBegin())), 
 | |
|     End = SM.getDecomposedLoc(SM.getFileLoc(RegionOfInterest.getEnd())); 
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (End.first != Begin.first) {
 | |
|     // If the end does not reside in the same file, try to recover by
 | |
|     // picking the end of the file of begin location.
 | |
|     End.first = Begin.first;
 | |
|     End.second = SM.getFileIDSize(Begin.first);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   assert(Begin.first == End.first);
 | |
|   if (Begin.second > End.second)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   FileID File = Begin.first;
 | |
|   unsigned Offset = Begin.second;
 | |
|   unsigned Length = End.second - Begin.second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!VisitDeclsOnly && !VisitPreprocessorLast)
 | |
|     if (visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion())
 | |
|       return true; // visitation break.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (visitDeclsFromFileRegion(File, Offset, Length))
 | |
|     return true; // visitation break.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!VisitDeclsOnly && VisitPreprocessorLast)
 | |
|     return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static bool isInLexicalContext(Decl *D, DeclContext *DC) {
 | |
|   if (!DC)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (DeclContext *DeclDC = D->getLexicalDeclContext();
 | |
|          DeclDC; DeclDC = DeclDC->getLexicalParent()) {
 | |
|     if (DeclDC == DC)
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::visitDeclsFromFileRegion(FileID File,
 | |
|                                              unsigned Offset, unsigned Length) {
 | |
|   ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   SourceRange Range = RegionOfInterest;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SmallVector<Decl *, 16> Decls;
 | |
|   Unit->findFileRegionDecls(File, Offset, Length, Decls);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If we didn't find any file level decls for the file, try looking at the
 | |
|   // file that it was included from.
 | |
|   while (Decls.empty() || Decls.front()->isTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer()) {
 | |
|     bool Invalid = false;
 | |
|     const SrcMgr::SLocEntry &SLEntry = SM.getSLocEntry(File, &Invalid);
 | |
|     if (Invalid)
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceLocation Outer;
 | |
|     if (SLEntry.isFile())
 | |
|       Outer = SLEntry.getFile().getIncludeLoc();
 | |
|     else
 | |
|       Outer = SLEntry.getExpansion().getExpansionLocStart();
 | |
|     if (Outer.isInvalid())
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     std::tie(File, Offset) = SM.getDecomposedExpansionLoc(Outer);
 | |
|     Length = 0;
 | |
|     Unit->findFileRegionDecls(File, Offset, Length, Decls);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   assert(!Decls.empty());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool VisitedAtLeastOnce = false;
 | |
|   DeclContext *CurDC = nullptr;
 | |
|   SmallVectorImpl<Decl *>::iterator DIt = Decls.begin();
 | |
|   for (SmallVectorImpl<Decl *>::iterator DE = Decls.end(); DIt != DE; ++DIt) {
 | |
|     Decl *D = *DIt;
 | |
|     if (D->getSourceRange().isInvalid())
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (isInLexicalContext(D, CurDC))
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     CurDC = dyn_cast<DeclContext>(D);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (!TD->isFreeStanding())
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     RangeComparisonResult CompRes = RangeCompare(SM, D->getSourceRange(),Range);
 | |
|     if (CompRes == RangeBefore)
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     if (CompRes == RangeAfter)
 | |
|       break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     assert(CompRes == RangeOverlap);
 | |
|     VisitedAtLeastOnce = true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       FileDI_current = &DIt;
 | |
|       FileDE_current = DE;
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       FileDI_current = nullptr;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, Range), /*CheckedRegionOfInterest=*/true))
 | |
|       return true; // visitation break.
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (VisitedAtLeastOnce)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // No Decls overlapped with the range. Move up the lexical context until there
 | |
|   // is a context that contains the range or we reach the translation unit
 | |
|   // level.
 | |
|   DeclContext *DC = DIt == Decls.begin() ? (*DIt)->getLexicalDeclContext()
 | |
|                                          : (*(DIt-1))->getLexicalDeclContext();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (DC && !DC->isTranslationUnit()) {
 | |
|     Decl *D = cast<Decl>(DC);
 | |
|     SourceRange CurDeclRange = D->getSourceRange();
 | |
|     if (CurDeclRange.isInvalid())
 | |
|       break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (RangeCompare(SM, CurDeclRange, Range) == RangeOverlap) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, Range), /*CheckedRegionOfInterest=*/true))
 | |
|         return true; // visitation break.
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     DC = D->getLexicalDeclContext();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion() {
 | |
|   if (!AU->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PreprocessingRecord &PPRec
 | |
|     = *AU->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord();
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = AU->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) {
 | |
|     SourceRange MappedRange = AU->mapRangeToPreamble(RegionOfInterest);
 | |
|     SourceLocation B = MappedRange.getBegin();
 | |
|     SourceLocation E = MappedRange.getEnd();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (AU->isInPreambleFileID(B)) {
 | |
|       if (SM.isLoadedSourceLocation(E))
 | |
|         return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange(B, E),
 | |
|                                                  PPRec, *this);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       // Beginning of range lies in the preamble but it also extends beyond
 | |
|       // it into the main file. Split the range into 2 parts, one covering
 | |
|       // the preamble and another covering the main file. This allows subsequent
 | |
|       // calls to visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange to accept a source range that
 | |
|       // lies in the same FileID, allowing it to skip preprocessed entities that
 | |
|       // do not come from the same FileID.
 | |
|       bool breaked =
 | |
|         visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(
 | |
|                                    SourceRange(B, AU->getEndOfPreambleFileID()),
 | |
|                                           PPRec, *this);
 | |
|       if (breaked) return true;
 | |
|       return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(
 | |
|                                     SourceRange(AU->getStartOfMainFileID(), E),
 | |
|                                         PPRec, *this);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange(B, E), PPRec, *this);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool OnlyLocalDecls
 | |
|     = !AU->isMainFileAST() && AU->getOnlyLocalDecls(); 
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (OnlyLocalDecls)
 | |
|     return visitPreprocessedEntities(PPRec.local_begin(), PPRec.local_end(),
 | |
|                                      PPRec);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return visitPreprocessedEntities(PPRec.begin(), PPRec.end(), PPRec);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| template<typename InputIterator>
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::visitPreprocessedEntities(InputIterator First,
 | |
|                                               InputIterator Last,
 | |
|                                               PreprocessingRecord &PPRec,
 | |
|                                               FileID FID) {
 | |
|   for (; First != Last; ++First) {
 | |
|     if (!FID.isInvalid() && !PPRec.isEntityInFileID(First, FID))
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     PreprocessedEntity *PPE = *First;
 | |
|     if (!PPE)
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (MacroExpansion *ME = dyn_cast<MacroExpansion>(PPE)) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeMacroExpansionCursor(ME, TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (MacroDefinitionRecord *MD = dyn_cast<MacroDefinitionRecord>(PPE)) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeMacroDefinitionCursor(MD, TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (InclusionDirective *ID = dyn_cast<InclusionDirective>(PPE)) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeInclusionDirectiveCursor(ID, TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|       
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Visit the children of the given cursor.
 | |
| /// 
 | |
| /// \returns true if the visitation should be aborted, false if it
 | |
| /// should continue.
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitChildren(CXCursor Cursor) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isReference(Cursor.kind) && 
 | |
|       Cursor.kind != CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier) {
 | |
|     // By definition, references have no children.
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Set the Parent field to Cursor, then back to its old value once we're
 | |
|   // done.
 | |
|   SetParentRAII SetParent(Parent, StmtParent, Cursor);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(Cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     Decl *D = const_cast<Decl *>(getCursorDecl(Cursor));
 | |
|     if (!D)
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return VisitAttributes(D) || Visit(D);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(Cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(Cursor))
 | |
|       return Visit(S);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(Cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(Cursor))
 | |
|       return Visit(E);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isTranslationUnit(Cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(Cursor);
 | |
|     ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|     
 | |
|     int VisitOrder[2] = { VisitPreprocessorLast, !VisitPreprocessorLast };
 | |
|     for (unsigned I = 0; I != 2; ++I) {
 | |
|       if (VisitOrder[I]) {
 | |
|         if (!CXXUnit->isMainFileAST() && CXXUnit->getOnlyLocalDecls() &&
 | |
|             RegionOfInterest.isInvalid()) {
 | |
|           for (ASTUnit::top_level_iterator TL = CXXUnit->top_level_begin(),
 | |
|                                         TLEnd = CXXUnit->top_level_end();
 | |
|                TL != TLEnd; ++TL) {
 | |
|             const Optional<bool> V = handleDeclForVisitation(*TL);
 | |
|             if (!V.hasValue())
 | |
|               continue;
 | |
|             return V.getValue();
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         } else if (VisitDeclContext(
 | |
|                                 CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       // Walk the preprocessing record.
 | |
|       if (CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord())
 | |
|         visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier) {
 | |
|     if (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Base = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(Cursor)) {
 | |
|       if (TypeSourceInfo *BaseTSInfo = Base->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
 | |
|         return Visit(BaseTSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr) {
 | |
|     const IBOutletCollectionAttr *A =
 | |
|       cast<IBOutletCollectionAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(Cursor));
 | |
|     if (const ObjCObjectType *ObjT = A->getInterface()->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
 | |
|       return Visit(cxcursor::MakeCursorObjCClassRef(
 | |
|           ObjT->getInterface(),
 | |
|           A->getInterfaceLoc()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TU));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If pointing inside a macro definition, check if the token is an identifier
 | |
|   // that was ever defined as a macro. In such a case, create a "pseudo" macro
 | |
|   // expansion cursor for that token.
 | |
|   SourceLocation BeginLoc = RegionOfInterest.getBegin();
 | |
|   if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition &&
 | |
|       BeginLoc == RegionOfInterest.getEnd()) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation Loc = AU->mapLocationToPreamble(BeginLoc);
 | |
|     const MacroInfo *MI =
 | |
|         getMacroInfo(cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(Cursor), TU);
 | |
|     if (MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef =
 | |
|             checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Loc, TU))
 | |
|       return Visit(cxcursor::MakeMacroExpansionCursor(MacroDef, BeginLoc, TU));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Nothing to visit at the moment.
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitBlockDecl(BlockDecl *B) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = B->getSignatureAsWritten())
 | |
|     if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Stmt *Body = B->getBody())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Body, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Optional<bool> CursorVisitor::shouldVisitCursor(CXCursor Cursor) {
 | |
|   if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) {
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = getFullCursorExtent(Cursor, AU->getSourceManager());
 | |
|     if (Range.isInvalid())
 | |
|       return None;
 | |
|     
 | |
|     switch (CompareRegionOfInterest(Range)) {
 | |
|     case RangeBefore:
 | |
|       // This declaration comes before the region of interest; skip it.
 | |
|       return None;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case RangeAfter:
 | |
|       // This declaration comes after the region of interest; we're done.
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case RangeOverlap:
 | |
|       // This declaration overlaps the region of interest; visit it.
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return true;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclContext(DeclContext *DC) {
 | |
|   DeclContext::decl_iterator I = DC->decls_begin(), E = DC->decls_end();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: Eventually remove.  This part of a hack to support proper
 | |
|   // iteration over all Decls contained lexically within an ObjC container.
 | |
|   SaveAndRestore<DeclContext::decl_iterator*> DI_saved(DI_current, &I);
 | |
|   SaveAndRestore<DeclContext::decl_iterator> DE_saved(DE_current, E);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for ( ; I != E; ++I) {
 | |
|     Decl *D = *I;
 | |
|     if (D->getLexicalDeclContext() != DC)
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     // Filter out synthesized property accessor redeclarations.
 | |
|     if (isa<ObjCImplDecl>(DC))
 | |
|       if (auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|         if (OMD->isSynthesizedAccessorStub())
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|     const Optional<bool> V = handleDeclForVisitation(D);
 | |
|     if (!V.hasValue())
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     return V.getValue();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Optional<bool> CursorVisitor::handleDeclForVisitation(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Ignore synthesized ivars here, otherwise if we have something like:
 | |
|   //   @synthesize prop = _prop;
 | |
|   // and '_prop' is not declared, we will encounter a '_prop' ivar before
 | |
|   // encountering the 'prop' synthesize declaration and we will think that
 | |
|   // we passed the region-of-interest.
 | |
|   if (auto *ivarD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     if (ivarD->getSynthesize())
 | |
|       return None;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: ObjCClassRef/ObjCProtocolRef for forward class/protocol
 | |
|   // declarations is a mismatch with the compiler semantics.
 | |
|   if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl) {
 | |
|     auto *ID = cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D);
 | |
|     if (!ID->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|       Cursor = MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ID, ID->getLocation(), TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   } else if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCProtocolDecl) {
 | |
|     auto *PD = cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(D);
 | |
|     if (!PD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|       Cursor = MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(PD, PD->getLocation(), TU);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Optional<bool> V = shouldVisitCursor(Cursor);
 | |
|   if (!V.hasValue())
 | |
|     return None;
 | |
|   if (!V.getValue())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   if (Visit(Cursor, true))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   return None;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTranslationUnitDecl(TranslationUnitDecl *D) {
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Translation units are visited directly by Visit()");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeAliasTemplateDecl(TypeAliasTemplateDecl *D) {
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(D->getTemplatedDecl(), TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeAliasDecl(TypeAliasDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|     return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypedefDecl(TypedefDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|     return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTagDecl(TagDecl *D) {
 | |
|   return VisitDeclContext(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplateSpecializationDecl(
 | |
|                                           ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *D) {
 | |
|   bool ShouldVisitBody = false;
 | |
|   switch (D->getSpecializationKind()) {
 | |
|   case TSK_Undeclared:
 | |
|   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
 | |
|     // Nothing to visit
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
 | |
|   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
 | |
|     ShouldVisitBody = true;
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // Visit the template arguments used in the specialization.
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *SpecType = D->getTypeAsWritten()) {
 | |
|     TypeLoc TL = SpecType->getTypeLoc();
 | |
|     if (TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TSTLoc =
 | |
|             TL.getAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>()) {
 | |
|       for (unsigned I = 0, N = TSTLoc.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I)
 | |
|         if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TSTLoc.getArgLoc(I)))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return ShouldVisitBody && VisitCXXRecordDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl(
 | |
|                                    ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the TagDecl
 | |
|   // before visiting these template parameters.
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Visit the partial specialization arguments.
 | |
|   const ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo *Info = D->getTemplateArgsAsWritten();
 | |
|   const TemplateArgumentLoc *TemplateArgs = Info->getTemplateArgs();
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = Info->NumTemplateArgs; I != N; ++I)
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TemplateArgs[I]))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return VisitCXXRecordDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTypeParmDecl(TemplateTypeParmDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (const auto *TC = D->getTypeConstraint())
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(TC->getImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(), StmtParent,
 | |
|                            TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Visit the default argument.
 | |
|   if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited())
 | |
|     if (TypeSourceInfo *DefArg = D->getDefaultArgumentInfo())
 | |
|       if (Visit(DefArg->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitEnumConstantDecl(EnumConstantDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (Expr *Init = D->getInitExpr())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
 | |
|   unsigned NumParamList = DD->getNumTemplateParameterLists();
 | |
|   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumParamList; i++) {
 | |
|     TemplateParameterList* Params = DD->getTemplateParameterList(i);
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateParameters(Params))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = DD->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|     if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = DD->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static bool HasTrailingReturnType(FunctionDecl *ND) {
 | |
|   const QualType Ty = ND->getType();
 | |
|   if (const FunctionType *AFT = Ty->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
 | |
|     if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(AFT))
 | |
|       return FT->hasTrailingReturn();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Compare two base or member initializers based on their source order.
 | |
| static int CompareCXXCtorInitializers(CXXCtorInitializer *const *X,
 | |
|                                       CXXCtorInitializer *const *Y) {
 | |
|   return (*X)->getSourceOrder() - (*Y)->getSourceOrder();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *ND) {
 | |
|   unsigned NumParamList = ND->getNumTemplateParameterLists();
 | |
|   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumParamList; i++) {
 | |
|     TemplateParameterList* Params = ND->getTemplateParameterList(i);
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateParameters(Params))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ND->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
 | |
|     // Visit the function declaration's syntactic components in the order
 | |
|     // written. This requires a bit of work.
 | |
|     TypeLoc TL = TSInfo->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens();
 | |
|     FunctionTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>();
 | |
|     const bool HasTrailingRT = HasTrailingReturnType(ND);
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // If we have a function declared directly (without the use of a typedef),
 | |
|     // visit just the return type. Otherwise, just visit the function's type
 | |
|     // now.
 | |
|     if ((FTL && !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(ND) && !HasTrailingRT &&
 | |
|          Visit(FTL.getReturnLoc())) ||
 | |
|         (!FTL && Visit(TL)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present.
 | |
|     if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = ND->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|       if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // Visit the declaration name.
 | |
|     if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(ND))
 | |
|       if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(ND->getNameInfo()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // FIXME: Visit explicitly-specified template arguments!
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // Visit the function parameters, if we have a function type.
 | |
|     if (FTL && VisitFunctionTypeLoc(FTL, true))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Visit the function's trailing return type.
 | |
|     if (FTL && HasTrailingRT && Visit(FTL.getReturnLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // FIXME: Attributes?
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (ND->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && !ND->isLateTemplateParsed()) {
 | |
|     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ND)) {
 | |
|       // Find the initializers that were written in the source.
 | |
|       SmallVector<CXXCtorInitializer *, 4> WrittenInits;
 | |
|       for (auto *I : Constructor->inits()) {
 | |
|         if (!I->isWritten())
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|       
 | |
|         WrittenInits.push_back(I);
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       
 | |
|       // Sort the initializers in source order
 | |
|       llvm::array_pod_sort(WrittenInits.begin(), WrittenInits.end(),
 | |
|                            &CompareCXXCtorInitializers);
 | |
|       
 | |
|       // Visit the initializers in source order
 | |
|       for (unsigned I = 0, N = WrittenInits.size(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|         CXXCtorInitializer *Init = WrittenInits[I];
 | |
|         if (Init->isAnyMemberInitializer()) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(Init->getAnyMember(),
 | |
|                                         Init->getMemberLocation(), TU)))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         } else if (TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = Init->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         
 | |
|         // Visit the initializer value.
 | |
|         if (Expr *Initializer = Init->getInit())
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Initializer, ND, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|       } 
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(ND->getBody(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitFieldDecl(FieldDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Expr *BitWidth = D->getBitWidth())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(BitWidth, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Expr *Init = D->getInClassInitializer())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitVarDecl(VarDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Expr *Init = D->getInit())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitNonTypeTemplateParmDecl(NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited())
 | |
|     if (Expr *DefArg = D->getDefaultArgument())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCXCursor(DefArg, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;  
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionTemplateDecl(FunctionTemplateDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the FunctionDecl
 | |
|   // before visiting these template parameters.
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   auto* FD = D->getTemplatedDecl();
 | |
|   return VisitAttributes(FD) || VisitFunctionDecl(FD);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplateDecl(ClassTemplateDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the TagDecl
 | |
|   // before visiting these template parameters.
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   auto* CD = D->getTemplatedDecl();
 | |
|   return VisitAttributes(CD) || VisitCXXRecordDecl(CD);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited() &&
 | |
|       VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(D->getDefaultArgument()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamDecl(ObjCTypeParamDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit the bound, if it's explicit.
 | |
|   if (D->hasExplicitBound()) {
 | |
|     if (auto TInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCMethodDecl(ObjCMethodDecl *ND) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ND->getReturnTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|     if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (const auto *P : ND->parameters()) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(P, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return ND->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
 | |
|          Visit(MakeCXCursor(ND->getBody(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| template <typename DeclIt>
 | |
| static void addRangedDeclsInContainer(DeclIt *DI_current, DeclIt DE_current,
 | |
|                                       SourceManager &SM, SourceLocation EndLoc,
 | |
|                                       SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &Decls) {
 | |
|   DeclIt next = *DI_current;
 | |
|   while (++next != DE_current) {
 | |
|     Decl *D_next = *next;
 | |
|     if (!D_next)
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     SourceLocation L = D_next->getBeginLoc();
 | |
|     if (!L.isValid())
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L, EndLoc)) {
 | |
|       *DI_current = next;
 | |
|       Decls.push_back(D_next);
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCContainerDecl(ObjCContainerDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: Eventually convert back to just 'VisitDeclContext()'.  Essentially
 | |
|   // an @implementation can lexically contain Decls that are not properly
 | |
|   // nested in the AST.  When we identify such cases, we need to retrofit
 | |
|   // this nesting here.
 | |
|   if (!DI_current && !FileDI_current)
 | |
|     return VisitDeclContext(D);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Scan the Decls that immediately come after the container
 | |
|   // in the current DeclContext.  If any fall within the
 | |
|   // container's lexical region, stash them into a vector
 | |
|   // for later processing.
 | |
|   SmallVector<Decl *, 24> DeclsInContainer;
 | |
|   SourceLocation EndLoc = D->getSourceRange().getEnd();
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = AU->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   if (EndLoc.isValid()) {
 | |
|     if (DI_current) {
 | |
|       addRangedDeclsInContainer(DI_current, DE_current, SM, EndLoc,
 | |
|                                 DeclsInContainer);
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       addRangedDeclsInContainer(FileDI_current, FileDE_current, SM, EndLoc,
 | |
|                                 DeclsInContainer);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // The common case.
 | |
|   if (DeclsInContainer.empty())
 | |
|     return VisitDeclContext(D);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Get all the Decls in the DeclContext, and sort them with the
 | |
|   // additional ones we've collected.  Then visit them.
 | |
|   for (auto *SubDecl : D->decls()) {
 | |
|     if (!SubDecl || SubDecl->getLexicalDeclContext() != D ||
 | |
|         SubDecl->getBeginLoc().isInvalid())
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     DeclsInContainer.push_back(SubDecl);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Now sort the Decls so that they appear in lexical order.
 | |
|   llvm::sort(DeclsInContainer,
 | |
|              [&SM](Decl *A, Decl *B) {
 | |
|                SourceLocation L_A = A->getBeginLoc();
 | |
|                SourceLocation L_B = B->getBeginLoc();
 | |
|                return L_A != L_B ? SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L_A, L_B)
 | |
|                                  : SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(A->getEndLoc(),
 | |
|                                                                 B->getEndLoc());
 | |
|              });
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Now visit the decls.
 | |
|   for (SmallVectorImpl<Decl*>::iterator I = DeclsInContainer.begin(),
 | |
|          E = DeclsInContainer.end(); I != E; ++I) {
 | |
|     CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(*I, TU, RegionOfInterest);
 | |
|     const Optional<bool> &V = shouldVisitCursor(Cursor);
 | |
|     if (!V.hasValue())
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     if (!V.getValue())
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
|     if (Visit(Cursor, true))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCCategoryDecl(ObjCCategoryDecl *ND) {
 | |
|   if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ND->getClassInterface(), ND->getLocation(),
 | |
|                                    TU)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (VisitObjCTypeParamList(ND->getTypeParamList()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = ND->protocol_loc_begin();
 | |
|   for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator I = ND->protocol_begin(),
 | |
|          E = ND->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL)
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitObjCContainerDecl(ND);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCProtocolDecl(ObjCProtocolDecl *PID) {
 | |
|   if (!PID->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(PID, PID->getLocation(), TU));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = PID->protocol_loc_begin();
 | |
|   for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PID->protocol_begin(),
 | |
|        E = PID->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL)
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitObjCContainerDecl(PID);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCPropertyDecl(ObjCPropertyDecl *PD) {
 | |
|   if (PD->getTypeSourceInfo() && Visit(PD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: This implements a workaround with @property declarations also being
 | |
|   // installed in the DeclContext for the @interface.  Eventually this code
 | |
|   // should be removed.
 | |
|   ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(PD->getDeclContext());
 | |
|   if (!CDecl || !CDecl->IsClassExtension())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = CDecl->getClassInterface();
 | |
|   if (!ID)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   IdentifierInfo *PropertyId = PD->getIdentifier();
 | |
|   ObjCPropertyDecl *prevDecl =
 | |
|     ObjCPropertyDecl::findPropertyDecl(cast<DeclContext>(ID), PropertyId,
 | |
|                                        PD->getQueryKind());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!prevDecl)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Visit synthesized methods since they will be skipped when visiting
 | |
|   // the @interface.
 | |
|   if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = prevDecl->getGetterMethodDecl())
 | |
|     if (MD->isPropertyAccessor() && MD->getLexicalDeclContext() == CDecl)
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(MD, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = prevDecl->getSetterMethodDecl())
 | |
|     if (MD->isPropertyAccessor() && MD->getLexicalDeclContext() == CDecl)
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(MD, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamList(ObjCTypeParamList *typeParamList) {
 | |
|   if (!typeParamList)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (auto *typeParam : *typeParamList) {
 | |
|     // Visit the type parameter.
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(typeParam, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCInterfaceDecl(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (!D->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
 | |
|     // Forward declaration is treated like a reference.
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(D, D->getLocation(), TU));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Objective-C type parameters.
 | |
|   if (VisitObjCTypeParamList(D->getTypeParamListAsWritten()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Issue callbacks for super class.
 | |
|   if (D->getSuperClass() &&
 | |
|       Visit(MakeCursorObjCSuperClassRef(D->getSuperClass(),
 | |
|                                         D->getSuperClassLoc(),
 | |
|                                         TU)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *SuperClassTInfo = D->getSuperClassTInfo())
 | |
|     if (Visit(SuperClassTInfo->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ObjCInterfaceDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = D->protocol_loc_begin();
 | |
|   for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::protocol_iterator I = D->protocol_begin(),
 | |
|          E = D->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL)
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitObjCContainerDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCImplDecl(ObjCImplDecl *D) {
 | |
|   return VisitObjCContainerDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCCategoryImplDecl(ObjCCategoryImplDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // 'ID' could be null when dealing with invalid code.
 | |
|   if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = D->getClassInterface())
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ID, D->getLocation(), TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitObjCImplDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCImplementationDecl(ObjCImplementationDecl *D) {
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|   // Issue callbacks for super class.
 | |
|   // FIXME: No source location information!
 | |
|   if (D->getSuperClass() &&
 | |
|       Visit(MakeCursorObjCSuperClassRef(D->getSuperClass(),
 | |
|                                         D->getSuperClassLoc(),
 | |
|                                         TU)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitObjCImplDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCPropertyImplDecl(ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PD) {
 | |
|   if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = PD->getPropertyIvarDecl())
 | |
|     if (PD->isIvarNameSpecified())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(Ivar, PD->getPropertyIvarDeclLoc(), TU));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitNamespaceDecl(NamespaceDecl *D) {
 | |
|   return VisitDeclContext(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitNamespaceAliasDecl(NamespaceAliasDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(D->getAliasedNamespace(), 
 | |
|                                       D->getTargetNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUsingDecl(UsingDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) {
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(D, D->getLocation(), TU)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|     
 | |
|   return VisitDeclarationNameInfo(D->getNameInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUsingDirectiveDecl(UsingDirectiveDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(D->getNominatedNamespaceAsWritten(),
 | |
|                                       D->getIdentLocation(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingValueDecl(UnresolvedUsingValueDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) {
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitDeclarationNameInfo(D->getNameInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl(
 | |
|                                                UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitStaticAssertDecl(StaticAssertDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D->getAssertExpr(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   if (StringLiteral *Message = D->getMessage())
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Message, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitFriendDecl(FriendDecl *D) {
 | |
|   if (NamedDecl *FriendD = D->getFriendDecl()) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(FriendD, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   } else if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = D->getFriendType()) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(TI->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclarationNameInfo(DeclarationNameInfo Name) {
 | |
|   switch (Name.getName().getNameKind()) {
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::Identifier:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXUsingDirective:
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName:
 | |
|     if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = Name.getNamedTypeInfo())
 | |
|       return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCZeroArgSelector:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCOneArgSelector:
 | |
|   case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCMultiArgSelector:
 | |
|     // FIXME: Per-identifier location info?
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Invalid DeclarationName::Kind!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 
 | |
|                                              SourceRange Range) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: This whole routine is a hack to work around the lack of proper
 | |
|   // source information in nested-name-specifiers (PR5791). Since we do have
 | |
|   // a beginning source location, we can visit the first component of the
 | |
|   // nested-name-specifier, if it's a single-token component.
 | |
|   if (!NNS)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // Get the first component in the nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   while (NestedNameSpecifier *Prefix = NNS->getPrefix())
 | |
|     NNS = Prefix;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   switch (NNS->getKind()) {
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespace(), Range.getBegin(),
 | |
|                                         TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias(), 
 | |
|                                         Range.getBegin(), TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: {
 | |
|     // If the type has a form where we know that the beginning of the source
 | |
|     // range matches up with a reference cursor. Visit the appropriate reference
 | |
|     // cursor.
 | |
|     const Type *T = NNS->getAsType();
 | |
|     if (const TypedefType *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Typedef->getDecl(), Range.getBegin(), TU));
 | |
|     if (const TagType *Tag = dyn_cast<TagType>(T))
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Tag->getDecl(), Range.getBegin(), TU));
 | |
|     if (const TemplateSpecializationType *TST
 | |
|                                       = dyn_cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(T))
 | |
|       return VisitTemplateName(TST->getTemplateName(), Range.getBegin());
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate:
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
 | |
|   case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
 | |
|     break;      
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool 
 | |
| CursorVisitor::VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier) {
 | |
|   SmallVector<NestedNameSpecifierLoc, 4> Qualifiers;
 | |
|   for (; Qualifier; Qualifier = Qualifier.getPrefix())
 | |
|     Qualifiers.push_back(Qualifier);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   while (!Qualifiers.empty()) {
 | |
|     NestedNameSpecifierLoc Q = Qualifiers.pop_back_val();
 | |
|     NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Q.getNestedNameSpecifier();
 | |
|     switch (NNS->getKind()) {
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespace(), 
 | |
|                                        Q.getLocalBeginLoc(),
 | |
|                                        TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|         
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|       
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias(), 
 | |
|                                        Q.getLocalBeginLoc(),
 | |
|                                        TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|         
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|         
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate:
 | |
|       if (Visit(Q.getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|         
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|         
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
 | |
|     case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
 | |
|       break;              
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateParameters(
 | |
|                                           const TemplateParameterList *Params) {
 | |
|   if (!Params)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
 | |
|                                           PEnd = Params->end();
 | |
|        P != PEnd; ++P) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(*P, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateName(TemplateName Name, SourceLocation Loc) {
 | |
|   switch (Name.getKind()) {
 | |
|   case TemplateName::Template:
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(Name.getAsTemplateDecl(), Loc, TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
 | |
|     // Visit the overloaded template set.
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Name, Loc, TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateName::AssumedTemplate:
 | |
|     // FIXME: Visit DeclarationName?
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate:
 | |
|     // FIXME: Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
 | |
|     // FIXME: Visit nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(
 | |
|                                   Name.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()->getDecl(), 
 | |
|                                        Loc, TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm:
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(
 | |
|                          Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm()->getParameter(),
 | |
|                                        Loc, TU));
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack:
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(
 | |
|                   Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack()->getParameterPack(),
 | |
|                                        Loc, TU));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Invalid TemplateName::Kind!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(const TemplateArgumentLoc &TAL) {
 | |
|   switch (TAL.getArgument().getKind()) {
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Null:
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Integral:
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Pack:
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Type:
 | |
|     if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TAL.getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|       return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|       
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Declaration:
 | |
|     if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceDeclExpression())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
 | |
|     if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceNullPtrExpression())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Expression:
 | |
|     if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceExpression())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::Template:
 | |
|   case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TAL.getTemplateQualifierLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|       
 | |
|     return VisitTemplateName(TAL.getArgument().getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern(), 
 | |
|                              TAL.getTemplateNameLoc());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Invalid TemplateArgument::Kind!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitLinkageSpecDecl(LinkageSpecDecl *D) {
 | |
|   return VisitDeclContext(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitQualifiedTypeLoc(QualifiedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getUnqualifiedLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitBuiltinTypeLoc(BuiltinTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   ASTContext &Context = AU->getASTContext();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Some builtin types (such as Objective-C's "id", "sel", and
 | |
|   // "Class") have associated declarations. Create cursors for those.
 | |
|   QualType VisitType;
 | |
|   switch (TL.getTypePtr()->getKind()) {
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::Void:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::Dependent:
 | |
| #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
 | |
| #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtTYpe, Id, Ext) \
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
 | |
| #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
 | |
| #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
 | |
| #define SIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #define UNSIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #define FLOATING_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
 | |
| #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
 | |
|     break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
 | |
|     VisitType = Context.getObjCIdType();
 | |
|     break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
 | |
|     VisitType = Context.getObjCClassType();
 | |
|     break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
 | |
|     VisitType = Context.getObjCSelType();
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!VisitType.isNull()) {
 | |
|     if (const TypedefType *Typedef = VisitType->getAs<TypedefType>())
 | |
|       return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Typedef->getDecl(), TL.getBuiltinLoc(),
 | |
|                                      TU));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypedefTypeLoc(TypedefTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getTypedefNameDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingTypeLoc(UnresolvedUsingTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTagTypeLoc(TagTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (TL.isDefinition())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(TL.getDecl(), TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTypeParmTypeLoc(TemplateTypeParmTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCInterfaceTypeLoc(ObjCInterfaceTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(TL.getIFaceDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamTypeLoc(ObjCTypeParamTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getBeginLoc(), TU)))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumProtocols(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(TL.getProtocol(I), TL.getProtocolLoc(I),
 | |
|                                         TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCObjectTypeLoc(ObjCObjectTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (TL.hasBaseTypeAsWritten() && Visit(TL.getBaseLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumTypeArgs(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(TL.getTypeArgTInfo(I)->getTypeLoc()))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumProtocols(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|     if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(TL.getProtocol(I), TL.getProtocolLoc(I),
 | |
|                                         TU)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc(ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitParenTypeLoc(ParenTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getInnerLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitMacroQualifiedTypeLoc(MacroQualifiedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getInnerLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitPointerTypeLoc(PointerTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitBlockPointerTypeLoc(BlockPointerTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitMemberPointerTypeLoc(MemberPointerTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitLValueReferenceTypeLoc(LValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitRValueReferenceTypeLoc(RValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitAttributedTypeLoc(AttributedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getModifiedLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionTypeLoc(FunctionTypeLoc TL, 
 | |
|                                          bool SkipResultType) {
 | |
|   if (!SkipResultType && Visit(TL.getReturnLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumParams(); I != N; ++I)
 | |
|     if (Decl *D = TL.getParam(I))
 | |
|       if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitArrayTypeLoc(ArrayTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (Visit(TL.getElementLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Expr *Size = TL.getSizeExpr())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Size, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDecayedTypeLoc(DecayedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getOriginalLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitAdjustedTypeLoc(AdjustedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getOriginalLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeducedTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc(
 | |
|     DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateName(TL.getTypePtr()->getTemplateName(), 
 | |
|                         TL.getTemplateNameLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc(
 | |
|                                              TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   // Visit the template name.
 | |
|   if (VisitTemplateName(TL.getTypePtr()->getTemplateName(), 
 | |
|                         TL.getTemplateNameLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // Visit the template arguments.
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I)
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TL.getArgLoc(I)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeOfExprTypeLoc(TypeOfExprTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCXCursor(TL.getUnderlyingExpr(), StmtParent, TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeOfTypeLoc(TypeOfTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TL.getUnderlyingTInfo())
 | |
|     return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnaryTransformTypeLoc(UnaryTransformTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TL.getUnderlyingTInfo())
 | |
|     return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDependentNameTypeLoc(DependentNameTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc(
 | |
|                                     DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if there is one.
 | |
|   if (TL.getQualifierLoc() &&
 | |
|       VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // Visit the template arguments.
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I)
 | |
|     if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TL.getArgLoc(I)))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitElaboratedTypeLoc(ElaboratedTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc()))
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getNamedTypeLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitPackExpansionTypeLoc(PackExpansionTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getPatternLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitDecltypeTypeLoc(DecltypeTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   if (Expr *E = TL.getUnderlyingExpr())
 | |
|     return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitInjectedClassNameTypeLoc(InjectedClassNameTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitAtomicTypeLoc(AtomicTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getValueLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitPipeTypeLoc(PipeTypeLoc TL) {
 | |
|   return Visit(TL.getValueLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #define DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(CLASS, PARENT) \
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::Visit##CLASS##TypeLoc(CLASS##TypeLoc TL) { \
 | |
|   return Visit##PARENT##Loc(TL); \
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Complex, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(ConstantArray, ArrayType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(IncompleteArray, ArrayType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(VariableArray, ArrayType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentSizedArray, ArrayType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentAddressSpace, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentVector, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentSizedExtVector, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Vector, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(ExtVector, VectorType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(FunctionProto, FunctionType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(FunctionNoProto, FunctionType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Record, TagType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Enum, TagType)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(SubstTemplateTypeParm, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(SubstTemplateTypeParmPack, Type)
 | |
| DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Auto, Type)
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitCXXRecordDecl(CXXRecordDecl *D) {
 | |
|   // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (D->isCompleteDefinition()) {
 | |
|     for (const auto &I : D->bases()) {
 | |
|       if (Visit(cxcursor::MakeCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(&I, TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return VisitTagDecl(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::VisitAttributes(Decl *D) {
 | |
|   for (const auto *I : D->attrs())
 | |
|     if ((TU->ParsingOptions & CXTranslationUnit_VisitImplicitAttributes ||
 | |
|          !I->isImplicit()) &&
 | |
|         Visit(MakeCXCursor(I, D, TU)))
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Data-recursive visitor methods.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| #define DEF_JOB(NAME, DATA, KIND)\
 | |
| class NAME : public VisitorJob {\
 | |
| public:\
 | |
|   NAME(const DATA *d, CXCursor parent) : \
 | |
|       VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::KIND, d) {} \
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { return VJ->getKind() == KIND; }\
 | |
|   const DATA *get() const { return static_cast<const DATA*>(data[0]); }\
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| DEF_JOB(StmtVisit, Stmt, StmtVisitKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(MemberExprParts, MemberExpr, MemberExprPartsKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(DeclRefExprParts, DeclRefExpr, DeclRefExprPartsKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(OverloadExprParts, OverloadExpr, OverloadExprPartsKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(SizeOfPackExprParts, SizeOfPackExpr, SizeOfPackExprPartsKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(LambdaExprParts, LambdaExpr, LambdaExprPartsKind)
 | |
| DEF_JOB(PostChildrenVisit, void, PostChildrenVisitKind)
 | |
| #undef DEF_JOB
 | |
| 
 | |
| class ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit(const TemplateArgumentLoc *Begin,
 | |
|                             const TemplateArgumentLoc *End, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|       : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind, Begin,
 | |
|                    End) {}
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const TemplateArgumentLoc *begin() const {
 | |
|     return static_cast<const TemplateArgumentLoc *>(data[0]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const TemplateArgumentLoc *end() {
 | |
|     return static_cast<const TemplateArgumentLoc *>(data[1]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| class DeclVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   DeclVisit(const Decl *D, CXCursor parent, bool isFirst) :
 | |
|     VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::DeclVisitKind,
 | |
|                D, isFirst ? (void*) 1 : (void*) nullptr) {}
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == DeclVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const Decl *get() const { return static_cast<const Decl *>(data[0]); }
 | |
|   bool isFirst() const { return data[1] != nullptr; }
 | |
| };
 | |
| class TypeLocVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   TypeLocVisit(TypeLoc tl, CXCursor parent) :
 | |
|     VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::TypeLocVisitKind,
 | |
|                tl.getType().getAsOpaquePtr(), tl.getOpaqueData()) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == TypeLocVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TypeLoc get() const { 
 | |
|     QualType T = QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(data[0]);
 | |
|     return TypeLoc(T, const_cast<void *>(data[1]));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| class LabelRefVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   LabelRefVisit(LabelDecl *LD, SourceLocation labelLoc, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|     : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind, LD,
 | |
|                  labelLoc.getPtrEncoding()) {}
 | |
|   
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const LabelDecl *get() const {
 | |
|     return static_cast<const LabelDecl *>(data[0]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   SourceLocation getLoc() const { 
 | |
|     return SourceLocation::getFromPtrEncoding(data[1]); }
 | |
| };
 | |
|   
 | |
| class NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|     : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind,
 | |
|                  Qualifier.getNestedNameSpecifier(),
 | |
|                  Qualifier.getOpaqueData()) { }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   NestedNameSpecifierLoc get() const {
 | |
|     return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(
 | |
|             const_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(
 | |
|               static_cast<const NestedNameSpecifier *>(data[0])),
 | |
|             const_cast<void *>(data[1]));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
|   
 | |
| class DeclarationNameInfoVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   DeclarationNameInfoVisit(const Stmt *S, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|     : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind, S) {}
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   DeclarationNameInfo get() const {
 | |
|     const Stmt *S = static_cast<const Stmt *>(data[0]);
 | |
|     switch (S->getStmtClass()) {
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       llvm_unreachable("Unhandled Stmt");
 | |
|     case clang::Stmt::MSDependentExistsStmtClass:
 | |
|       return cast<MSDependentExistsStmt>(S)->getNameInfo();
 | |
|     case Stmt::CXXDependentScopeMemberExprClass:
 | |
|       return cast<CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr>(S)->getMemberNameInfo();
 | |
|     case Stmt::DependentScopeDeclRefExprClass:
 | |
|       return cast<DependentScopeDeclRefExpr>(S)->getNameInfo();
 | |
|     case Stmt::OMPCriticalDirectiveClass:
 | |
|       return cast<OMPCriticalDirective>(S)->getDirectiveName();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| class MemberRefVisit : public VisitorJob {
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   MemberRefVisit(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|     : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind, D,
 | |
|                  L.getPtrEncoding()) {}
 | |
|   static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) {
 | |
|     return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const FieldDecl *get() const {
 | |
|     return static_cast<const FieldDecl *>(data[0]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   SourceLocation getLoc() const {
 | |
|     return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding((unsigned)(uintptr_t) data[1]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| class EnqueueVisitor : public ConstStmtVisitor<EnqueueVisitor, void> {
 | |
|   friend class OMPClauseEnqueue;
 | |
|   VisitorWorkList &WL;
 | |
|   CXCursor Parent;
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   EnqueueVisitor(VisitorWorkList &wl, CXCursor parent)
 | |
|     : WL(wl), Parent(parent) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
|   void VisitAddrLabelExpr(const AddrLabelExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitBlockExpr(const BlockExpr *B);
 | |
|   void VisitCompoundLiteralExpr(const CompoundLiteralExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCompoundStmt(const CompoundStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(const CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { /* Do nothing. */ }
 | |
|   void VisitMSDependentExistsStmt(const MSDependentExistsStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXDependentScopeMemberExpr(const CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXNewExpr(const CXXNewExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXScalarValueInitExpr(const CXXScalarValueInitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(const CXXOperatorCallExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXPseudoDestructorExpr(const CXXPseudoDestructorExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXTemporaryObjectExpr(const CXXTemporaryObjectExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXTypeidExpr(const CXXTypeidExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXUnresolvedConstructExpr(const CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXUuidofExpr(const CXXUuidofExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXCatchStmt(const CXXCatchStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitCXXForRangeStmt(const CXXForRangeStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitDeclRefExpr(const DeclRefExpr *D);
 | |
|   void VisitDeclStmt(const DeclStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitDependentScopeDeclRefExpr(const DependentScopeDeclRefExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitDesignatedInitExpr(const DesignatedInitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitExplicitCastExpr(const ExplicitCastExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitForStmt(const ForStmt *FS);
 | |
|   void VisitGotoStmt(const GotoStmt *GS);
 | |
|   void VisitIfStmt(const IfStmt *If);
 | |
|   void VisitInitListExpr(const InitListExpr *IE);
 | |
|   void VisitMemberExpr(const MemberExpr *M);
 | |
|   void VisitOffsetOfExpr(const OffsetOfExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitObjCEncodeExpr(const ObjCEncodeExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitObjCMessageExpr(const ObjCMessageExpr *M);
 | |
|   void VisitOverloadExpr(const OverloadExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(const UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitStmt(const Stmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitSwitchStmt(const SwitchStmt *S);
 | |
|   void VisitWhileStmt(const WhileStmt *W);
 | |
|   void VisitTypeTraitExpr(const TypeTraitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitArrayTypeTraitExpr(const ArrayTypeTraitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitExpressionTraitExpr(const ExpressionTraitExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitUnresolvedMemberExpr(const UnresolvedMemberExpr *U);
 | |
|   void VisitVAArgExpr(const VAArgExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitSizeOfPackExpr(const SizeOfPackExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitPseudoObjectExpr(const PseudoObjectExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitOpaqueValueExpr(const OpaqueValueExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitLambdaExpr(const LambdaExpr *E);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPExecutableDirective(const OMPExecutableDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPLoopDirective(const OMPLoopDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelDirective(const OMPParallelDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPSimdDirective(const OMPSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPForDirective(const OMPForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPForSimdDirective(const OMPForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPSectionsDirective(const OMPSectionsDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPSectionDirective(const OMPSectionDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPSingleDirective(const OMPSingleDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPMasterDirective(const OMPMasterDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPCriticalDirective(const OMPCriticalDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelForDirective(const OMPParallelForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelForSimdDirective(const OMPParallelForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelMasterDirective(const OMPParallelMasterDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelSectionsDirective(const OMPParallelSectionsDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskDirective(const OMPTaskDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskyieldDirective(const OMPTaskyieldDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPBarrierDirective(const OMPBarrierDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskwaitDirective(const OMPTaskwaitDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskgroupDirective(const OMPTaskgroupDirective *D);
 | |
|   void
 | |
|   VisitOMPCancellationPointDirective(const OMPCancellationPointDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPCancelDirective(const OMPCancelDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPFlushDirective(const OMPFlushDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPDepobjDirective(const OMPDepobjDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPOrderedDirective(const OMPOrderedDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPAtomicDirective(const OMPAtomicDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetDirective(const OMPTargetDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetDataDirective(const OMPTargetDataDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetEnterDataDirective(const OMPTargetEnterDataDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetExitDataDirective(const OMPTargetExitDataDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetParallelDirective(const OMPTargetParallelDirective *D);
 | |
|   void
 | |
|   VisitOMPTargetParallelForDirective(const OMPTargetParallelForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTeamsDirective(const OMPTeamsDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskLoopDirective(const OMPTaskLoopDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTaskLoopSimdDirective(const OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPMasterTaskLoopDirective(const OMPMasterTaskLoopDirective *D);
 | |
|   void
 | |
|   VisitOMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective(const OMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPDistributeDirective(const OMPDistributeDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPDistributeParallelForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPDistributeSimdDirective(const OMPDistributeSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetSimdDirective(const OMPTargetSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeDirective(const OMPTeamsDistributeDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDirective(const OMPTargetTeamsDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective(
 | |
|       const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D);
 | |
| 
 | |
| private:
 | |
|   void AddDeclarationNameInfo(const Stmt *S);
 | |
|   void AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier);
 | |
|   void AddExplicitTemplateArgs(const TemplateArgumentLoc *A,
 | |
|                                unsigned NumTemplateArgs);
 | |
|   void AddMemberRef(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L);
 | |
|   void AddStmt(const Stmt *S);
 | |
|   void AddDecl(const Decl *D, bool isFirst = true);
 | |
|   void AddTypeLoc(TypeSourceInfo *TI);
 | |
|   void EnqueueChildren(const Stmt *S);
 | |
|   void EnqueueChildren(const OMPClause *S);
 | |
| };
 | |
| } // end anonyous namespace
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddDeclarationNameInfo(const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   // 'S' should always be non-null, since it comes from the
 | |
|   // statement we are visiting.
 | |
|   WL.push_back(DeclarationNameInfoVisit(S, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void 
 | |
| EnqueueVisitor::AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier) {
 | |
|   if (Qualifier)
 | |
|     WL.push_back(NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit(Qualifier, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddStmt(const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   if (S)
 | |
|     WL.push_back(StmtVisit(S, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddDecl(const Decl *D, bool isFirst) {
 | |
|   if (D)
 | |
|     WL.push_back(DeclVisit(D, Parent, isFirst));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddExplicitTemplateArgs(const TemplateArgumentLoc *A,
 | |
|                                              unsigned NumTemplateArgs) {
 | |
|   WL.push_back(ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit(A, A + NumTemplateArgs, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddMemberRef(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L) {
 | |
|   if (D)
 | |
|     WL.push_back(MemberRefVisit(D, L, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::AddTypeLoc(TypeSourceInfo *TI) {
 | |
|   if (TI)
 | |
|     WL.push_back(TypeLocVisit(TI->getTypeLoc(), Parent));
 | |
|  }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::EnqueueChildren(const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   unsigned size = WL.size();
 | |
|   for (const Stmt *SubStmt : S->children()) {
 | |
|     AddStmt(SubStmt);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (size == WL.size())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS
 | |
|   // ordering performed by the worklist.
 | |
|   VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end();
 | |
|   std::reverse(I, E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| class OMPClauseEnqueue : public ConstOMPClauseVisitor<OMPClauseEnqueue> {
 | |
|   EnqueueVisitor *Visitor;
 | |
|   /// Process clauses with list of variables.
 | |
|   template <typename T>
 | |
|   void VisitOMPClauseList(T *Node);
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   OMPClauseEnqueue(EnqueueVisitor *Visitor) : Visitor(Visitor) { }
 | |
| #define OPENMP_CLAUSE(Name, Class)                                             \
 | |
|   void Visit##Class(const Class *C);
 | |
| #include "clang/Basic/OpenMPKinds.def"
 | |
|   void VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(const OMPClauseWithPreInit *C);
 | |
|   void VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(const OMPClauseWithPostUpdate *C);
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(
 | |
|     const OMPClauseWithPreInit *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPreInitStmt());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(
 | |
|     const OMPClauseWithPostUpdate *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPostUpdateExpr());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPIfClause(const OMPIfClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCondition());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFinalClause(const OMPFinalClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCondition());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumThreadsClause(const OMPNumThreadsClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumThreads());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSafelenClause(const OMPSafelenClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getSafelen());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSimdlenClause(const OMPSimdlenClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getSimdlen());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAllocatorClause(const OMPAllocatorClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getAllocator());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCollapseClause(const OMPCollapseClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumForLoops());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDefaultClause(const OMPDefaultClause *C) { }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPProcBindClause(const OMPProcBindClause *C) { }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPScheduleClause(const OMPScheduleClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getChunkSize());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPOrderedClause(const OMPOrderedClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumForLoops());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNowaitClause(const OMPNowaitClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUntiedClause(const OMPUntiedClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPMergeableClause(const OMPMergeableClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReadClause(const OMPReadClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPWriteClause(const OMPWriteClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUpdateClause(const OMPUpdateClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCaptureClause(const OMPCaptureClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSeqCstClause(const OMPSeqCstClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAcqRelClause(const OMPAcqRelClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAcquireClause(const OMPAcquireClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReleaseClause(const OMPReleaseClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPRelaxedClause(const OMPRelaxedClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPThreadsClause(const OMPThreadsClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSIMDClause(const OMPSIMDClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNogroupClause(const OMPNogroupClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDestroyClause(const OMPDestroyClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUnifiedAddressClause(
 | |
|     const OMPUnifiedAddressClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUnifiedSharedMemoryClause(
 | |
|     const OMPUnifiedSharedMemoryClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReverseOffloadClause(
 | |
|     const OMPReverseOffloadClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDynamicAllocatorsClause(
 | |
|     const OMPDynamicAllocatorsClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAtomicDefaultMemOrderClause(
 | |
|     const OMPAtomicDefaultMemOrderClause *) {}
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDeviceClause(const OMPDeviceClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getDevice());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumTeamsClause(const OMPNumTeamsClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumTeams());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPThreadLimitClause(const OMPThreadLimitClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getThreadLimit());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPPriorityClause(const OMPPriorityClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPriority());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPGrainsizeClause(const OMPGrainsizeClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getGrainsize());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumTasksClause(const OMPNumTasksClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumTasks());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPHintClause(const OMPHintClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getHint());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| template<typename T>
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseList(T *Node) {
 | |
|   for (const auto *I : Node->varlists()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(I);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAllocateClause(const OMPAllocateClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getAllocator());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPPrivateClause(const OMPPrivateClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->private_copies()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFirstprivateClause(
 | |
|                                         const OMPFirstprivateClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->private_copies()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->inits()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPLastprivateClause(
 | |
|                                         const OMPLastprivateClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->private_copies()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSharedClause(const OMPSharedClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReductionClause(const OMPReductionClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->privates()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPTaskReductionClause(
 | |
|     const OMPTaskReductionClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->privates()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPInReductionClause(
 | |
|     const OMPInReductionClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->privates()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->taskgroup_descriptors())
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPLinearClause(const OMPLinearClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C);
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->privates()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->inits()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->updates()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->finals()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getStep());
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCalcStep());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAlignedClause(const OMPAlignedClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getAlignment());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCopyinClause(const OMPCopyinClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void
 | |
| OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCopyprivateClause(const OMPCopyprivateClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) {
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFlushClause(const OMPFlushClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDepobjClause(const OMPDepobjClause *C) {
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getDepobj());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDependClause(const OMPDependClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPMapClause(const OMPMapClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDistScheduleClause(
 | |
|     const OMPDistScheduleClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C);
 | |
|   Visitor->AddStmt(C->getChunkSize());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDefaultmapClause(
 | |
|     const OMPDefaultmapClause * /*C*/) {}
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPToClause(const OMPToClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFromClause(const OMPFromClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUseDevicePtrClause(const OMPUseDevicePtrClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPIsDevicePtrClause(const OMPIsDevicePtrClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNontemporalClause(
 | |
|     const OMPNontemporalClause *C) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPClauseList(C);
 | |
|   for (const auto *E : C->private_refs())
 | |
|     Visitor->AddStmt(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPOrderClause(const OMPOrderClause *C) {}
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::EnqueueChildren(const OMPClause *S) {
 | |
|   unsigned size = WL.size();
 | |
|   OMPClauseEnqueue Visitor(this);
 | |
|   Visitor.Visit(S);
 | |
|   if (size == WL.size())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS
 | |
|   // ordering performed by the worklist.
 | |
|   VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end();
 | |
|   std::reverse(I, E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitAddrLabelExpr(const AddrLabelExpr *E) {
 | |
|   WL.push_back(LabelRefVisit(E->getLabel(), E->getLabelLoc(), Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitBlockExpr(const BlockExpr *B) {
 | |
|   AddDecl(B->getBlockDecl());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCompoundLiteralExpr(const CompoundLiteralExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCompoundStmt(const CompoundStmt *S) {
 | |
|   for (auto &I : llvm::reverse(S->body()))
 | |
|     AddStmt(I);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::
 | |
| VisitMSDependentExistsStmt(const MSDependentExistsStmt *S) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(S->getSubStmt());
 | |
|   AddDeclarationNameInfo(S);
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = S->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::
 | |
| VisitCXXDependentScopeMemberExpr(const CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *E) {
 | |
|   if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
 | |
|     AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs());
 | |
|   AddDeclarationNameInfo(E);
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = E->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
 | |
|   if (!E->isImplicitAccess())
 | |
|     AddStmt(E->getBase());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXNewExpr(const CXXNewExpr *E) {
 | |
|   // Enqueue the initializer , if any.
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getInitializer());
 | |
|   // Enqueue the array size, if any.
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getArraySize().getValueOr(nullptr));
 | |
|   // Enqueue the allocated type.
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getAllocatedTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
|   // Enqueue the placement arguments.
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = E->getNumPlacementArgs(); I > 0; --I)
 | |
|     AddStmt(E->getPlacementArg(I-1));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(const CXXOperatorCallExpr *CE) {
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = CE->getNumArgs(); I > 1 /* Yes, this is 1 */; --I)
 | |
|     AddStmt(CE->getArg(I-1));
 | |
|   AddStmt(CE->getCallee());
 | |
|   AddStmt(CE->getArg(0));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXPseudoDestructorExpr(
 | |
|                                         const CXXPseudoDestructorExpr *E) {
 | |
|   // Visit the name of the type being destroyed.
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getDestroyedTypeInfo());
 | |
|   // Visit the scope type that looks disturbingly like the nested-name-specifier
 | |
|   // but isn't.
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getScopeTypeInfo());
 | |
|   // Visit the nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|   if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = E->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|     AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
 | |
|   // Visit base expression.
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getBase());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXScalarValueInitExpr(
 | |
|                                         const CXXScalarValueInitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXTemporaryObjectExpr(
 | |
|                                         const CXXTemporaryObjectExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXTypeidExpr(const CXXTypeidExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   if (E->isTypeOperand())
 | |
|     AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeOperandSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXUnresolvedConstructExpr(
 | |
|                                         const CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXUuidofExpr(const CXXUuidofExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   if (E->isTypeOperand())
 | |
|     AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeOperandSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXCatchStmt(const CXXCatchStmt *S) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(S);
 | |
|   AddDecl(S->getExceptionDecl());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXForRangeStmt(const CXXForRangeStmt *S) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(S->getBody());
 | |
|   AddStmt(S->getRangeInit());
 | |
|   AddDecl(S->getLoopVariable());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDeclRefExpr(const DeclRefExpr *DR) {
 | |
|   if (DR->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
 | |
|     AddExplicitTemplateArgs(DR->getTemplateArgs(), DR->getNumTemplateArgs());
 | |
|   WL.push_back(DeclRefExprParts(DR, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDependentScopeDeclRefExpr(
 | |
|                                         const DependentScopeDeclRefExpr *E) {
 | |
|   if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
 | |
|     AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs());
 | |
|   AddDeclarationNameInfo(E);
 | |
|   AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(E->getQualifierLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDeclStmt(const DeclStmt *S) {
 | |
|   unsigned size = WL.size();
 | |
|   bool isFirst = true;
 | |
|   for (const auto *D : S->decls()) {
 | |
|     AddDecl(D, isFirst);
 | |
|     isFirst = false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (size == WL.size())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS
 | |
|   // ordering performed by the worklist.
 | |
|   VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end();
 | |
|   std::reverse(I, E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDesignatedInitExpr(const DesignatedInitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getInit());
 | |
|   for (const DesignatedInitExpr::Designator &D :
 | |
|        llvm::reverse(E->designators())) {
 | |
|     if (D.isFieldDesignator()) {
 | |
|       if (FieldDecl *Field = D.getField())
 | |
|         AddMemberRef(Field, D.getFieldLoc());
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     if (D.isArrayDesignator()) {
 | |
|       AddStmt(E->getArrayIndex(D));
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     assert(D.isArrayRangeDesignator() && "Unknown designator kind");
 | |
|     AddStmt(E->getArrayRangeEnd(D));
 | |
|     AddStmt(E->getArrayRangeStart(D));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitExplicitCastExpr(const ExplicitCastExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeInfoAsWritten());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitForStmt(const ForStmt *FS) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(FS->getBody());
 | |
|   AddStmt(FS->getInc());
 | |
|   AddStmt(FS->getCond());
 | |
|   AddDecl(FS->getConditionVariable());
 | |
|   AddStmt(FS->getInit());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitGotoStmt(const GotoStmt *GS) {
 | |
|   WL.push_back(LabelRefVisit(GS->getLabel(), GS->getLabelLoc(), Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitIfStmt(const IfStmt *If) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(If->getElse());
 | |
|   AddStmt(If->getThen());
 | |
|   AddStmt(If->getCond());
 | |
|   AddDecl(If->getConditionVariable());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitInitListExpr(const InitListExpr *IE) {
 | |
|   // We care about the syntactic form of the initializer list, only.
 | |
|   if (InitListExpr *Syntactic = IE->getSyntacticForm())
 | |
|     IE = Syntactic;
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(IE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitMemberExpr(const MemberExpr *M) {
 | |
|   WL.push_back(MemberExprParts(M, Parent));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // If the base of the member access expression is an implicit 'this', don't
 | |
|   // visit it.
 | |
|   // FIXME: If we ever want to show these implicit accesses, this will be
 | |
|   // unfortunate. However, clang_getCursor() relies on this behavior.
 | |
|   if (M->isImplicitAccess())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Ignore base anonymous struct/union fields, otherwise they will shadow the
 | |
|   // real field that we are interested in.
 | |
|   if (auto *SubME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(M->getBase())) {
 | |
|     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(SubME->getMemberDecl())) {
 | |
|       if (FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
 | |
|         AddStmt(SubME->getBase());
 | |
|         return;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   AddStmt(M->getBase());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitObjCEncodeExpr(const ObjCEncodeExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getEncodedTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitObjCMessageExpr(const ObjCMessageExpr *M) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(M);
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(M->getClassReceiverTypeInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOffsetOfExpr(const OffsetOfExpr *E) {
 | |
|   // Visit the components of the offsetof expression.
 | |
|   for (unsigned N = E->getNumComponents(), I = N; I > 0; --I) {
 | |
|     const OffsetOfNode &Node = E->getComponent(I-1);
 | |
|     switch (Node.getKind()) {
 | |
|     case OffsetOfNode::Array:
 | |
|       AddStmt(E->getIndexExpr(Node.getArrayExprIndex()));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case OffsetOfNode::Field:
 | |
|       AddMemberRef(Node.getField(), Node.getSourceRange().getEnd());
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case OffsetOfNode::Identifier:
 | |
|     case OffsetOfNode::Base:
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   // Visit the type into which we're computing the offset.
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOverloadExpr(const OverloadExpr *E) {
 | |
|   if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
 | |
|     AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs());
 | |
|   WL.push_back(OverloadExprParts(E, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
 | |
|                                         const UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
|   if (E->isArgumentType())
 | |
|     AddTypeLoc(E->getArgumentTypeInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitStmt(const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(S);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitSwitchStmt(const SwitchStmt *S) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(S->getBody());
 | |
|   AddStmt(S->getCond());
 | |
|   AddDecl(S->getConditionVariable());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitWhileStmt(const WhileStmt *W) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(W->getBody());
 | |
|   AddStmt(W->getCond());
 | |
|   AddDecl(W->getConditionVariable());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitTypeTraitExpr(const TypeTraitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = E->getNumArgs(); I > 0; --I)
 | |
|     AddTypeLoc(E->getArg(I-1));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitArrayTypeTraitExpr(const ArrayTypeTraitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getQueriedTypeSourceInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitExpressionTraitExpr(const ExpressionTraitExpr *E) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitUnresolvedMemberExpr(const UnresolvedMemberExpr *U) {
 | |
|   VisitOverloadExpr(U);
 | |
|   if (!U->isImplicitAccess())
 | |
|     AddStmt(U->getBase());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitVAArgExpr(const VAArgExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getSubExpr());
 | |
|   AddTypeLoc(E->getWrittenTypeInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitSizeOfPackExpr(const SizeOfPackExpr *E) {
 | |
|   WL.push_back(SizeOfPackExprParts(E, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOpaqueValueExpr(const OpaqueValueExpr *E) {
 | |
|   // If the opaque value has a source expression, just transparently
 | |
|   // visit that.  This is useful for (e.g.) pseudo-object expressions.
 | |
|   if (Expr *SourceExpr = E->getSourceExpr())
 | |
|     return Visit(SourceExpr);
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitLambdaExpr(const LambdaExpr *E) {
 | |
|   AddStmt(E->getBody());
 | |
|   WL.push_back(LambdaExprParts(E, Parent));
 | |
| }
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitPseudoObjectExpr(const PseudoObjectExpr *E) {
 | |
|   // Treat the expression like its syntactic form.
 | |
|   Visit(E->getSyntacticForm());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPExecutableDirective(
 | |
|   const OMPExecutableDirective *D) {
 | |
|   EnqueueChildren(D);
 | |
|   for (ArrayRef<OMPClause *>::iterator I = D->clauses().begin(),
 | |
|                                        E = D->clauses().end();
 | |
|        I != E; ++I)
 | |
|     EnqueueChildren(*I);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPLoopDirective(const OMPLoopDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelDirective(const OMPParallelDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSimdDirective(const OMPSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPForDirective(const OMPForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPForSimdDirective(const OMPForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSectionsDirective(const OMPSectionsDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSectionDirective(const OMPSectionDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSingleDirective(const OMPSingleDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPMasterDirective(const OMPMasterDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCriticalDirective(const OMPCriticalDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
|   AddDeclarationNameInfo(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelForDirective(const OMPParallelForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPParallelForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelMasterDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPParallelMasterDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelSectionsDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPParallelSectionsDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskDirective(const OMPTaskDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskyieldDirective(const OMPTaskyieldDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPBarrierDirective(const OMPBarrierDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskwaitDirective(const OMPTaskwaitDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskgroupDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTaskgroupDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
|   if (const Expr *E = D->getReductionRef())
 | |
|     VisitStmt(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPFlushDirective(const OMPFlushDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDepobjDirective(const OMPDepobjDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPOrderedDirective(const OMPOrderedDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPAtomicDirective(const OMPAtomicDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetDirective(const OMPTargetDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetDataDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetDataDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetEnterDataDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetEnterDataDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetExitDataDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetExitDataDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetParallelDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelForDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetParallelForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDirective(const OMPTeamsDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCancellationPointDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPCancellationPointDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCancelDirective(const OMPCancelDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskLoopDirective(const OMPTaskLoopDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskLoopSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPMasterTaskLoopDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPMasterTaskLoopDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPDistributeDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPDistributeParallelForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPDistributeSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTeamsDistributeDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetTeamsDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective(
 | |
|     const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D) {
 | |
|   VisitOMPLoopDirective(D);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void CursorVisitor::EnqueueWorkList(VisitorWorkList &WL, const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   EnqueueVisitor(WL, MakeCXCursor(S, StmtParent, TU,RegionOfInterest)).Visit(S);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::IsInRegionOfInterest(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) {
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = getRawCursorExtent(C);
 | |
|     if (Range.isInvalid() || CompareRegionOfInterest(Range))
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return true;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::RunVisitorWorkList(VisitorWorkList &WL) {
 | |
|   while (!WL.empty()) {
 | |
|     // Dequeue the worklist item.
 | |
|     VisitorJob LI = WL.pop_back_val();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Set the Parent field, then back to its old value once we're done.
 | |
|     SetParentRAII SetParent(Parent, StmtParent, LI.getParent());
 | |
|   
 | |
|     switch (LI.getKind()) {
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::DeclVisitKind: {
 | |
|         const Decl *D = cast<DeclVisit>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         if (!D)
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         // For now, perform default visitation for Decls.
 | |
|         if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest,
 | |
|                                cast<DeclVisit>(&LI)->isFirst())))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind: {
 | |
|         for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg :
 | |
|              *cast<ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit>(&LI)) {
 | |
|           if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(Arg))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::TypeLocVisitKind: {
 | |
|         // Perform default visitation for TypeLocs.
 | |
|         if (Visit(cast<TypeLocVisit>(&LI)->get()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind: {
 | |
|         const LabelDecl *LS = cast<LabelRefVisit>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         if (LabelStmt *stmt = LS->getStmt()) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCursorLabelRef(stmt, cast<LabelRefVisit>(&LI)->getLoc(),
 | |
|                                        TU))) {
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind: {
 | |
|         NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit *V = cast<NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit>(&LI);
 | |
|         if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(V->get()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|         
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind: {
 | |
|         if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(cast<DeclarationNameInfoVisit>(&LI)
 | |
|                                      ->get()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind: {
 | |
|         MemberRefVisit *V = cast<MemberRefVisit>(&LI);
 | |
|         if (Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(V->get(), V->getLoc(), TU)))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::StmtVisitKind: {
 | |
|         const Stmt *S = cast<StmtVisit>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         if (!S)
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         // Update the current cursor.
 | |
|         CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(S, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest);
 | |
|         if (!IsInRegionOfInterest(Cursor))
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|         switch (Visitor(Cursor, Parent, ClientData)) {
 | |
|           case CXChildVisit_Break: return true;
 | |
|           case CXChildVisit_Continue: break;
 | |
|           case CXChildVisit_Recurse:
 | |
|             if (PostChildrenVisitor)
 | |
|               WL.push_back(PostChildrenVisit(nullptr, Cursor));
 | |
|             EnqueueWorkList(WL, S);
 | |
|             break;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::MemberExprPartsKind: {
 | |
|         // Handle the other pieces in the MemberExpr besides the base.
 | |
|         const MemberExpr *M = cast<MemberExprParts>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         
 | |
|         // Visit the nested-name-specifier
 | |
|         if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = M->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|           if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         
 | |
|         // Visit the declaration name.
 | |
|         if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(M->getMemberNameInfo()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         
 | |
|         // Visit the explicitly-specified template arguments, if any.
 | |
|         if (M->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
 | |
|           for (const TemplateArgumentLoc *Arg = M->getTemplateArgs(),
 | |
|                *ArgEnd = Arg + M->getNumTemplateArgs();
 | |
|                Arg != ArgEnd; ++Arg) {
 | |
|             if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(*Arg))
 | |
|               return true;
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::DeclRefExprPartsKind: {
 | |
|         const DeclRefExpr *DR = cast<DeclRefExprParts>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         // Visit nested-name-specifier, if present.
 | |
|         if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = DR->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|           if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         // Visit declaration name.
 | |
|         if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(DR->getNameInfo()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::OverloadExprPartsKind: {
 | |
|         const OverloadExpr *O = cast<OverloadExprParts>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         // Visit the nested-name-specifier.
 | |
|         if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = O->getQualifierLoc())
 | |
|           if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         // Visit the declaration name.
 | |
|         if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(O->getNameInfo()))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         // Visit the overloaded declaration reference.
 | |
|         if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(O, TU)))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::SizeOfPackExprPartsKind: {
 | |
|         const SizeOfPackExpr *E = cast<SizeOfPackExprParts>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         NamedDecl *Pack = E->getPack();
 | |
|         if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Pack)) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Pack),
 | |
|                                       E->getPackLoc(), TU)))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|           
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|           
 | |
|         if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Pack)) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Pack),
 | |
|                                           E->getPackLoc(), TU)))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|           
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         
 | |
|         // Non-type template parameter packs and function parameter packs are
 | |
|         // treated like DeclRefExpr cursors.
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|         
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::LambdaExprPartsKind: {
 | |
|         // Visit non-init captures.
 | |
|         const LambdaExpr *E = cast<LambdaExprParts>(&LI)->get();
 | |
|         for (LambdaExpr::capture_iterator C = E->explicit_capture_begin(),
 | |
|                                        CEnd = E->explicit_capture_end();
 | |
|              C != CEnd; ++C) {
 | |
|           if (!C->capturesVariable())
 | |
|             continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (Visit(MakeCursorVariableRef(C->getCapturedVar(),
 | |
|                                           C->getLocation(),
 | |
|                                           TU)))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         // Visit init captures
 | |
|         for (auto InitExpr : E->capture_inits()) {
 | |
|           if (Visit(InitExpr))
 | |
|             return true;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         
 | |
|         TypeLoc TL = E->getCallOperator()->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
 | |
|         // Visit parameters and return type, if present.
 | |
|         if (FunctionTypeLoc Proto = TL.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>()) {
 | |
|           if (E->hasExplicitParameters()) {
 | |
|             // Visit parameters.
 | |
|             for (unsigned I = 0, N = Proto.getNumParams(); I != N; ++I)
 | |
|               if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Proto.getParam(I), TU)))
 | |
|                 return true;
 | |
|           }
 | |
|           if (E->hasExplicitResultType()) {
 | |
|             // Visit result type.
 | |
|             if (Visit(Proto.getReturnLoc()))
 | |
|               return true;
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       case VisitorJob::PostChildrenVisitKind:
 | |
|         if (PostChildrenVisitor(Parent, ClientData))
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool CursorVisitor::Visit(const Stmt *S) {
 | |
|   VisitorWorkList *WL = nullptr;
 | |
|   if (!WorkListFreeList.empty()) {
 | |
|     WL = WorkListFreeList.back();
 | |
|     WL->clear();
 | |
|     WorkListFreeList.pop_back();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   else {
 | |
|     WL = new VisitorWorkList();
 | |
|     WorkListCache.push_back(WL);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   EnqueueWorkList(*WL, S);
 | |
|   bool result = RunVisitorWorkList(*WL);
 | |
|   WorkListFreeList.push_back(WL);
 | |
|   return result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| typedef SmallVector<SourceRange, 4> RefNamePieces;
 | |
| RefNamePieces buildPieces(unsigned NameFlags, bool IsMemberRefExpr,
 | |
|                           const DeclarationNameInfo &NI, SourceRange QLoc,
 | |
|                           const SourceRange *TemplateArgsLoc = nullptr) {
 | |
|   const bool WantQualifier = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantQualifier;
 | |
|   const bool WantTemplateArgs = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantTemplateArgs;
 | |
|   const bool WantSinglePiece = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const DeclarationName::NameKind Kind = NI.getName().getNameKind();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   RefNamePieces Pieces;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (WantQualifier && QLoc.isValid())
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(QLoc);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (Kind != DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || IsMemberRefExpr)
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(NI.getLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (WantTemplateArgs && TemplateArgsLoc && TemplateArgsLoc->isValid())
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(*TemplateArgsLoc);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Kind == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) {
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(
 | |
|                        NI.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc));
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(
 | |
|                        NI.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc));
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (WantSinglePiece) {
 | |
|     SourceRange R(Pieces.front().getBegin(), Pieces.back().getEnd());
 | |
|     Pieces.clear();
 | |
|     Pieces.push_back(R);
 | |
|   }  
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Pieces;  
 | |
| }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Misc. API hooks.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//               
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| struct RegisterFatalErrorHandler {
 | |
|   RegisterFatalErrorHandler() {
 | |
|     clang_install_aborting_llvm_fatal_error_handler();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static llvm::ManagedStatic<RegisterFatalErrorHandler> RegisterFatalErrorHandlerOnce;
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXIndex clang_createIndex(int excludeDeclarationsFromPCH,
 | |
|                           int displayDiagnostics) {
 | |
|   // We use crash recovery to make some of our APIs more reliable, implicitly
 | |
|   // enable it.
 | |
|   if (!getenv("LIBCLANG_DISABLE_CRASH_RECOVERY"))
 | |
|     llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Enable();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Look through the managed static to trigger construction of the managed
 | |
|   // static which registers our fatal error handler. This ensures it is only
 | |
|   // registered once.
 | |
|   (void)*RegisterFatalErrorHandlerOnce;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Initialize targets for clang module support.
 | |
|   llvm::InitializeAllTargets();
 | |
|   llvm::InitializeAllTargetMCs();
 | |
|   llvm::InitializeAllAsmPrinters();
 | |
|   llvm::InitializeAllAsmParsers();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CIndexer *CIdxr = new CIndexer();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (excludeDeclarationsFromPCH)
 | |
|     CIdxr->setOnlyLocalDecls();
 | |
|   if (displayDiagnostics)
 | |
|     CIdxr->setDisplayDiagnostics();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_INDEX"))
 | |
|     CIdxr->setCXGlobalOptFlags(CIdxr->getCXGlobalOptFlags() |
 | |
|                                CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing);
 | |
|   if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_EDIT"))
 | |
|     CIdxr->setCXGlobalOptFlags(CIdxr->getCXGlobalOptFlags() |
 | |
|                                CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CIdxr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeIndex(CXIndex CIdx) {
 | |
|   if (CIdx)
 | |
|     delete static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_CXIndex_setGlobalOptions(CXIndex CIdx, unsigned options) {
 | |
|   if (CIdx)
 | |
|     static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->setCXGlobalOptFlags(options);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXIndex_getGlobalOptions(CXIndex CIdx) {
 | |
|   if (CIdx)
 | |
|     return static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->getCXGlobalOptFlags();
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_CXIndex_setInvocationEmissionPathOption(CXIndex CIdx,
 | |
|                                                    const char *Path) {
 | |
|   if (CIdx)
 | |
|     static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->setInvocationEmissionPath(Path ? Path : "");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_toggleCrashRecovery(unsigned isEnabled) {
 | |
|   if (isEnabled)
 | |
|     llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Enable();
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Disable();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTranslationUnit clang_createTranslationUnit(CXIndex CIdx,
 | |
|                                               const char *ast_filename) {
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit TU;
 | |
|   enum CXErrorCode Result =
 | |
|       clang_createTranslationUnit2(CIdx, ast_filename, &TU);
 | |
|   (void)Result;
 | |
|   assert((TU && Result == CXError_Success) ||
 | |
|          (!TU && Result != CXError_Success));
 | |
|   return TU;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CXErrorCode clang_createTranslationUnit2(CXIndex CIdx,
 | |
|                                               const char *ast_filename,
 | |
|                                               CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) {
 | |
|   if (out_TU)
 | |
|     *out_TU = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!CIdx || !ast_filename || !out_TU)
 | |
|     return CXError_InvalidArguments;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << ast_filename;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CIndexer *CXXIdx = static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx);
 | |
|   FileSystemOptions FileSystemOpts;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   IntrusiveRefCntPtr<DiagnosticsEngine> Diags =
 | |
|       CompilerInstance::createDiagnostics(new DiagnosticOptions());
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> AU = ASTUnit::LoadFromASTFile(
 | |
|       ast_filename, CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations()->getRawReader(),
 | |
|       ASTUnit::LoadEverything, Diags,
 | |
|       FileSystemOpts, /*UseDebugInfo=*/false,
 | |
|       CXXIdx->getOnlyLocalDecls(), None,
 | |
|       CaptureDiagsKind::All,
 | |
|       /*AllowPCHWithCompilerErrors=*/true,
 | |
|       /*UserFilesAreVolatile=*/true);
 | |
|   *out_TU = MakeCXTranslationUnit(CXXIdx, std::move(AU));
 | |
|   return *out_TU ? CXError_Success : CXError_Failure;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_defaultEditingTranslationUnitOptions() {
 | |
|   return CXTranslationUnit_PrecompiledPreamble | 
 | |
|          CXTranslationUnit_CacheCompletionResults;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTranslationUnit
 | |
| clang_createTranslationUnitFromSourceFile(CXIndex CIdx,
 | |
|                                           const char *source_filename,
 | |
|                                           int num_command_line_args,
 | |
|                                           const char * const *command_line_args,
 | |
|                                           unsigned num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                           struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files) {
 | |
|   unsigned Options = CXTranslationUnit_DetailedPreprocessingRecord;
 | |
|   return clang_parseTranslationUnit(CIdx, source_filename,
 | |
|                                     command_line_args, num_command_line_args,
 | |
|                                     unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                     Options);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXErrorCode
 | |
| clang_parseTranslationUnit_Impl(CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename,
 | |
|                                 const char *const *command_line_args,
 | |
|                                 int num_command_line_args,
 | |
|                                 ArrayRef<CXUnsavedFile> unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                 unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) {
 | |
|   // Set up the initial return values.
 | |
|   if (out_TU)
 | |
|     *out_TU = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Check arguments.
 | |
|   if (!CIdx || !out_TU)
 | |
|     return CXError_InvalidArguments;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CIndexer *CXXIdx = static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing))
 | |
|     setThreadBackgroundPriority();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool PrecompilePreamble = options & CXTranslationUnit_PrecompiledPreamble;
 | |
|   bool CreatePreambleOnFirstParse =
 | |
|       options & CXTranslationUnit_CreatePreambleOnFirstParse;
 | |
|   // FIXME: Add a flag for modules.
 | |
|   TranslationUnitKind TUKind
 | |
|     = (options & (CXTranslationUnit_Incomplete |
 | |
|                   CXTranslationUnit_SingleFileParse))? TU_Prefix : TU_Complete;
 | |
|   bool CacheCodeCompletionResults
 | |
|     = options & CXTranslationUnit_CacheCompletionResults;
 | |
|   bool IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion
 | |
|     = options & CXTranslationUnit_IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion;
 | |
|   bool SingleFileParse = options & CXTranslationUnit_SingleFileParse;
 | |
|   bool ForSerialization = options & CXTranslationUnit_ForSerialization;
 | |
|   bool RetainExcludedCB = options &
 | |
|     CXTranslationUnit_RetainExcludedConditionalBlocks;
 | |
|   SkipFunctionBodiesScope SkipFunctionBodies = SkipFunctionBodiesScope::None;
 | |
|   if (options & CXTranslationUnit_SkipFunctionBodies) {
 | |
|     SkipFunctionBodies =
 | |
|         (options & CXTranslationUnit_LimitSkipFunctionBodiesToPreamble)
 | |
|             ? SkipFunctionBodiesScope::Preamble
 | |
|             : SkipFunctionBodiesScope::PreambleAndMainFile;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Configure the diagnostics.
 | |
|   IntrusiveRefCntPtr<DiagnosticsEngine>
 | |
|     Diags(CompilerInstance::createDiagnostics(new DiagnosticOptions));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (options & CXTranslationUnit_KeepGoing)
 | |
|     Diags->setFatalsAsError(true);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CaptureDiagsKind CaptureDiagnostics = CaptureDiagsKind::All;
 | |
|   if (options & CXTranslationUnit_IgnoreNonErrorsFromIncludedFiles)
 | |
|     CaptureDiagnostics = CaptureDiagsKind::AllWithoutNonErrorsFromIncludes;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function.
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<DiagnosticsEngine,
 | |
|     llvm::CrashRecoveryContextReleaseRefCleanup<DiagnosticsEngine> >
 | |
|     DiagCleanup(Diags.get());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>> RemappedFiles(
 | |
|       new std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function.
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<
 | |
|     std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile> > RemappedCleanup(RemappedFiles.get());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (auto &UF : unsaved_files) {
 | |
|     std::unique_ptr<llvm::MemoryBuffer> MB =
 | |
|         llvm::MemoryBuffer::getMemBufferCopy(getContents(UF), UF.Filename);
 | |
|     RemappedFiles->push_back(std::make_pair(UF.Filename, MB.release()));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<std::vector<const char *>> Args(
 | |
|       new std::vector<const char *>());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this method.
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<std::vector<const char*> >
 | |
|     ArgsCleanup(Args.get());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Since the Clang C library is primarily used by batch tools dealing with
 | |
|   // (often very broken) source code, where spell-checking can have a
 | |
|   // significant negative impact on performance (particularly when 
 | |
|   // precompiled headers are involved), we disable it by default.
 | |
|   // Only do this if we haven't found a spell-checking-related argument.
 | |
|   bool FoundSpellCheckingArgument = false;
 | |
|   for (int I = 0; I != num_command_line_args; ++I) {
 | |
|     if (strcmp(command_line_args[I], "-fno-spell-checking") == 0 ||
 | |
|         strcmp(command_line_args[I], "-fspell-checking") == 0) {
 | |
|       FoundSpellCheckingArgument = true;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   Args->insert(Args->end(), command_line_args,
 | |
|                command_line_args + num_command_line_args);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!FoundSpellCheckingArgument)
 | |
|     Args->insert(Args->begin() + 1, "-fno-spell-checking");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // The 'source_filename' argument is optional.  If the caller does not
 | |
|   // specify it then it is assumed that the source file is specified
 | |
|   // in the actual argument list.
 | |
|   // Put the source file after command_line_args otherwise if '-x' flag is
 | |
|   // present it will be unused.
 | |
|   if (source_filename)
 | |
|     Args->push_back(source_filename);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Do we need the detailed preprocessing record?
 | |
|   if (options & CXTranslationUnit_DetailedPreprocessingRecord) {
 | |
|     Args->push_back("-Xclang");
 | |
|     Args->push_back("-detailed-preprocessing-record");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Suppress any editor placeholder diagnostics.
 | |
|   Args->push_back("-fallow-editor-placeholders");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   unsigned NumErrors = Diags->getClient()->getNumErrors();
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> ErrUnit;
 | |
|   // Unless the user specified that they want the preamble on the first parse
 | |
|   // set it up to be created on the first reparse. This makes the first parse
 | |
|   // faster, trading for a slower (first) reparse.
 | |
|   unsigned PrecompilePreambleAfterNParses =
 | |
|       !PrecompilePreamble ? 0 : 2 - CreatePreambleOnFirstParse;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   LibclangInvocationReporter InvocationReporter(
 | |
|       *CXXIdx, LibclangInvocationReporter::OperationKind::ParseOperation,
 | |
|       options, llvm::makeArrayRef(*Args), /*InvocationArgs=*/None,
 | |
|       unsaved_files);
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> Unit(ASTUnit::LoadFromCommandLine(
 | |
|       Args->data(), Args->data() + Args->size(),
 | |
|       CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations(), Diags,
 | |
|       CXXIdx->getClangResourcesPath(), CXXIdx->getOnlyLocalDecls(),
 | |
|       CaptureDiagnostics, *RemappedFiles.get(),
 | |
|       /*RemappedFilesKeepOriginalName=*/true, PrecompilePreambleAfterNParses,
 | |
|       TUKind, CacheCodeCompletionResults, IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion,
 | |
|       /*AllowPCHWithCompilerErrors=*/true, SkipFunctionBodies, SingleFileParse,
 | |
|       /*UserFilesAreVolatile=*/true, ForSerialization, RetainExcludedCB,
 | |
|       CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations()->getRawReader().getFormat(),
 | |
|       &ErrUnit));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Early failures in LoadFromCommandLine may return with ErrUnit unset.
 | |
|   if (!Unit && !ErrUnit)
 | |
|     return CXError_ASTReadError;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (NumErrors != Diags->getClient()->getNumErrors()) {
 | |
|     // Make sure to check that 'Unit' is non-NULL.
 | |
|     if (CXXIdx->getDisplayDiagnostics())
 | |
|       printDiagsToStderr(Unit ? Unit.get() : ErrUnit.get());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isASTReadError(Unit ? Unit.get() : ErrUnit.get()))
 | |
|     return CXError_ASTReadError;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *out_TU = MakeCXTranslationUnit(CXXIdx, std::move(Unit));
 | |
|   if (CXTranslationUnitImpl *TU = *out_TU) {
 | |
|     TU->ParsingOptions = options;
 | |
|     TU->Arguments.reserve(Args->size());
 | |
|     for (const char *Arg : *Args)
 | |
|       TU->Arguments.push_back(Arg);
 | |
|     return CXError_Success;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return CXError_Failure;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTranslationUnit
 | |
| clang_parseTranslationUnit(CXIndex CIdx,
 | |
|                            const char *source_filename,
 | |
|                            const char *const *command_line_args,
 | |
|                            int num_command_line_args,
 | |
|                            struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
 | |
|                            unsigned num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|                            unsigned options) {
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit TU;
 | |
|   enum CXErrorCode Result = clang_parseTranslationUnit2(
 | |
|       CIdx, source_filename, command_line_args, num_command_line_args,
 | |
|       unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files, options, &TU);
 | |
|   (void)Result;
 | |
|   assert((TU && Result == CXError_Success) ||
 | |
|          (!TU && Result != CXError_Success));
 | |
|   return TU;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CXErrorCode clang_parseTranslationUnit2(
 | |
|     CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename,
 | |
|     const char *const *command_line_args, int num_command_line_args,
 | |
|     struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, unsigned num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|     unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) {
 | |
|   noteBottomOfStack();
 | |
|   SmallVector<const char *, 4> Args;
 | |
|   Args.push_back("clang");
 | |
|   Args.append(command_line_args, command_line_args + num_command_line_args);
 | |
|   return clang_parseTranslationUnit2FullArgv(
 | |
|       CIdx, source_filename, Args.data(), Args.size(), unsaved_files,
 | |
|       num_unsaved_files, options, out_TU);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CXErrorCode clang_parseTranslationUnit2FullArgv(
 | |
|     CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename,
 | |
|     const char *const *command_line_args, int num_command_line_args,
 | |
|     struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, unsigned num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|     unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) {
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << source_filename << ": ";
 | |
|     for (int i = 0; i != num_command_line_args; ++i)
 | |
|       *Log << command_line_args[i] << " ";
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (num_unsaved_files && !unsaved_files)
 | |
|     return CXError_InvalidArguments;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXErrorCode result = CXError_Failure;
 | |
|   auto ParseTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result] {
 | |
|     noteBottomOfStack();
 | |
|     result = clang_parseTranslationUnit_Impl(
 | |
|         CIdx, source_filename, command_line_args, num_command_line_args,
 | |
|         llvm::makeArrayRef(unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files), options, out_TU);
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!RunSafely(CRC, ParseTranslationUnitImpl)) {
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during parsing: {\n");
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'source_filename' : '%s'\n", source_filename);
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'command_line_args' : [");
 | |
|     for (int i = 0; i != num_command_line_args; ++i) {
 | |
|       if (i)
 | |
|         fprintf(stderr, ", ");
 | |
|       fprintf(stderr, "'%s'", command_line_args[i]);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "],\n");
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'unsaved_files' : [");
 | |
|     for (unsigned i = 0; i != num_unsaved_files; ++i) {
 | |
|       if (i)
 | |
|         fprintf(stderr, ", ");
 | |
|       fprintf(stderr, "('%s', '...', %ld)", unsaved_files[i].Filename,
 | |
|               unsaved_files[i].Length);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "],\n");
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'options' : %d,\n", options);
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "}\n");
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return CXError_Crashed;
 | |
|   } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) {
 | |
|     if (CXTranslationUnit *TU = out_TU)
 | |
|       PrintLibclangResourceUsage(*TU);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Type_getObjCEncoding(CXType CT) {
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit tu = static_cast<CXTranslationUnit>(CT.data[1]);
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = getASTUnit(tu)->getASTContext();
 | |
|   std::string encoding;
 | |
|   Ctx.getObjCEncodingForType(QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(CT.data[0]),
 | |
|                              encoding);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(encoding);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const IdentifierInfo *getMacroIdentifier(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) {
 | |
|     if (const MacroDefinitionRecord *MDR = getCursorMacroDefinition(C))
 | |
|       return MDR->getName();
 | |
|   } else if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) {
 | |
|     MacroExpansionCursor ME = getCursorMacroExpansion(C);
 | |
|     return ME.getName();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isMacroFunctionLike(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   const IdentifierInfo *II = getMacroIdentifier(C);
 | |
|   if (!II) {
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   ASTUnit *ASTU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = ASTU->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   if (const MacroInfo *MI = PP.getMacroInfo(II))
 | |
|     return MI->isFunctionLike();
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isMacroBuiltin(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   const IdentifierInfo *II = getMacroIdentifier(C);
 | |
|   if (!II) {
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   ASTUnit *ASTU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = ASTU->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   if (const MacroInfo *MI = PP.getMacroInfo(II))
 | |
|     return MI->isBuiltinMacro();
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isFunctionInlined(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
 | |
|   if (!FD) {
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return FD->isInlined();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static StringLiteral* getCFSTR_value(CallExpr *callExpr) {
 | |
|   if (callExpr->getNumArgs() != 1) {
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   StringLiteral *S = nullptr;
 | |
|   auto *arg = callExpr->getArg(0);
 | |
|   if (arg->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass) {
 | |
|     ImplicitCastExpr *I = static_cast<ImplicitCastExpr *>(arg);
 | |
|     auto *subExpr = I->getSubExprAsWritten();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if(subExpr->getStmtClass() != Stmt::StringLiteralClass){
 | |
|       return nullptr;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     S = static_cast<StringLiteral *>(I->getSubExprAsWritten());
 | |
|   } else if (arg->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass) {
 | |
|     S = static_cast<StringLiteral *>(callExpr->getArg(0));
 | |
|   } else {
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return S;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| struct ExprEvalResult {
 | |
|   CXEvalResultKind EvalType;
 | |
|   union {
 | |
|     unsigned long long unsignedVal;
 | |
|     long long intVal;
 | |
|     double floatVal;
 | |
|     char *stringVal;
 | |
|   } EvalData;
 | |
|   bool IsUnsignedInt;
 | |
|   ~ExprEvalResult() {
 | |
|     if (EvalType != CXEval_UnExposed && EvalType != CXEval_Float &&
 | |
|         EvalType != CXEval_Int) {
 | |
|       delete[] EvalData.stringVal;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_EvalResult_dispose(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   delete static_cast<ExprEvalResult *>(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXEvalResultKind clang_EvalResult_getKind(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   if (!E) {
 | |
|     return CXEval_UnExposed;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalType;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_EvalResult_getAsInt(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   return clang_EvalResult_getAsLongLong(E);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| long long clang_EvalResult_getAsLongLong(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   if (!E) {
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   ExprEvalResult *Result = (ExprEvalResult*)E;
 | |
|   if (Result->IsUnsignedInt)
 | |
|     return Result->EvalData.unsignedVal;
 | |
|   return Result->EvalData.intVal;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_EvalResult_isUnsignedInt(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->IsUnsignedInt;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned long long clang_EvalResult_getAsUnsigned(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   if (!E) {
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ExprEvalResult *Result = (ExprEvalResult*)E;
 | |
|   if (Result->IsUnsignedInt)
 | |
|     return Result->EvalData.unsignedVal;
 | |
|   return Result->EvalData.intVal;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| double clang_EvalResult_getAsDouble(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   if (!E) {
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalData.floatVal;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const char* clang_EvalResult_getAsStr(CXEvalResult E) {
 | |
|   if (!E) {
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalData.stringVal;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const ExprEvalResult* evaluateExpr(Expr *expr, CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   Expr::EvalResult ER;
 | |
|   ASTContext &ctx = getCursorContext(C);
 | |
|   if (!expr)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   expr = expr->IgnoreParens();
 | |
|   if (expr->isValueDependent())
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   if (!expr->EvaluateAsRValue(ER, ctx))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   QualType rettype;
 | |
|   CallExpr *callExpr;
 | |
|   auto result = std::make_unique<ExprEvalResult>();
 | |
|   result->EvalType = CXEval_UnExposed;
 | |
|   result->IsUnsignedInt = false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (ER.Val.isInt()) {
 | |
|     result->EvalType = CXEval_Int;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     auto& val = ER.Val.getInt();
 | |
|     if (val.isUnsigned()) {
 | |
|       result->IsUnsignedInt = true;
 | |
|       result->EvalData.unsignedVal = val.getZExtValue();
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       result->EvalData.intVal = val.getExtValue();
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return result.release();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (ER.Val.isFloat()) {
 | |
|     llvm::SmallVector<char, 100> Buffer;
 | |
|     ER.Val.getFloat().toString(Buffer);
 | |
|     std::string floatStr(Buffer.data(), Buffer.size());
 | |
|     result->EvalType = CXEval_Float;
 | |
|     bool ignored;
 | |
|     llvm::APFloat apFloat = ER.Val.getFloat();
 | |
|     apFloat.convert(llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble(),
 | |
|                     llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
 | |
|     result->EvalData.floatVal = apFloat.convertToDouble();
 | |
|     return result.release();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass) {
 | |
|     const ImplicitCastExpr *I = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(expr);
 | |
|     auto *subExpr = I->getSubExprAsWritten();
 | |
|     if (subExpr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass ||
 | |
|         subExpr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass) {
 | |
|       const StringLiteral *StrE = nullptr;
 | |
|       const ObjCStringLiteral *ObjCExpr;
 | |
|       ObjCExpr = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(subExpr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (ObjCExpr) {
 | |
|         StrE = ObjCExpr->getString();
 | |
|         result->EvalType = CXEval_ObjCStrLiteral;
 | |
|       } else {
 | |
|         StrE = cast<StringLiteral>(I->getSubExprAsWritten());
 | |
|         result->EvalType = CXEval_StrLiteral;
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       std::string strRef(StrE->getString().str());
 | |
|       result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strRef.size() + 1];
 | |
|       strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strRef.c_str(),
 | |
|               strRef.size());
 | |
|       result->EvalData.stringVal[strRef.size()] = '\0';
 | |
|       return result.release();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass ||
 | |
|              expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass) {
 | |
|     const StringLiteral *StrE = nullptr;
 | |
|     const ObjCStringLiteral *ObjCExpr;
 | |
|     ObjCExpr = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(expr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (ObjCExpr) {
 | |
|       StrE = ObjCExpr->getString();
 | |
|       result->EvalType = CXEval_ObjCStrLiteral;
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       StrE = cast<StringLiteral>(expr);
 | |
|       result->EvalType = CXEval_StrLiteral;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     std::string strRef(StrE->getString().str());
 | |
|     result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strRef.size() + 1];
 | |
|     strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strRef.c_str(), strRef.size());
 | |
|     result->EvalData.stringVal[strRef.size()] = '\0';
 | |
|     return result.release();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CStyleCastExprClass) {
 | |
|     CStyleCastExpr *CC = static_cast<CStyleCastExpr *>(expr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     rettype = CC->getType();
 | |
|     if (rettype.getAsString() == "CFStringRef" &&
 | |
|         CC->getSubExpr()->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CallExprClass) {
 | |
| 
 | |
|       callExpr = static_cast<CallExpr *>(CC->getSubExpr());
 | |
|       StringLiteral *S = getCFSTR_value(callExpr);
 | |
|       if (S) {
 | |
|         std::string strLiteral(S->getString().str());
 | |
|         result->EvalType = CXEval_CFStr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strLiteral.size() + 1];
 | |
|         strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strLiteral.c_str(),
 | |
|                 strLiteral.size());
 | |
|         result->EvalData.stringVal[strLiteral.size()] = '\0';
 | |
|         return result.release();
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CallExprClass) {
 | |
|     callExpr = static_cast<CallExpr *>(expr);
 | |
|     rettype = callExpr->getCallReturnType(ctx);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (rettype->isVectorType() || callExpr->getNumArgs() > 1)
 | |
|       return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (rettype->isIntegralType(ctx) || rettype->isRealFloatingType()) {
 | |
|       if (callExpr->getNumArgs() == 1 &&
 | |
|           !callExpr->getArg(0)->getType()->isIntegralType(ctx))
 | |
|         return nullptr;
 | |
|     } else if (rettype.getAsString() == "CFStringRef") {
 | |
| 
 | |
|       StringLiteral *S = getCFSTR_value(callExpr);
 | |
|       if (S) {
 | |
|         std::string strLiteral(S->getString().str());
 | |
|         result->EvalType = CXEval_CFStr;
 | |
|         result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strLiteral.size() + 1];
 | |
|         strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strLiteral.c_str(),
 | |
|                 strLiteral.size());
 | |
|         result->EvalData.stringVal[strLiteral.size()] = '\0';
 | |
|         return result.release();
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::DeclRefExprClass) {
 | |
|     DeclRefExpr *D = static_cast<DeclRefExpr *>(expr);
 | |
|     ValueDecl *V = D->getDecl();
 | |
|     if (V->getKind() == Decl::Function) {
 | |
|       std::string strName = V->getNameAsString();
 | |
|       result->EvalType = CXEval_Other;
 | |
|       result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strName.size() + 1];
 | |
|       strncpy(result->EvalData.stringVal, strName.c_str(), strName.size());
 | |
|       result->EvalData.stringVal[strName.size()] = '\0';
 | |
|       return result.release();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const Expr *evaluateDeclExpr(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   if (auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return Var->getInit();
 | |
|   else if (auto *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return Field->getInClassInitializer();
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const Expr *evaluateCompoundStmtExpr(const CompoundStmt *CS) {
 | |
|   assert(CS && "invalid compound statement");
 | |
|   for (auto *bodyIterator : CS->body()) {
 | |
|     if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<Expr>(bodyIterator))
 | |
|       return E;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXEvalResult clang_Cursor_Evaluate(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (const Expr *E =
 | |
|           clang_getCursorKind(C) == CXCursor_CompoundStmt
 | |
|               ? evaluateCompoundStmtExpr(cast<CompoundStmt>(getCursorStmt(C)))
 | |
|               : evaluateDeclExpr(getCursorDecl(C)))
 | |
|     return const_cast<CXEvalResult>(
 | |
|         reinterpret_cast<const void *>(evaluateExpr(const_cast<Expr *>(E), C)));
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_hasAttrs(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!D) {
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (D->hasAttrs()) {
 | |
|     return 1;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| unsigned clang_defaultSaveOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   return CXSaveTranslationUnit_None;
 | |
| }  
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXSaveError clang_saveTranslationUnit_Impl(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                                   const char *FileName,
 | |
|                                                   unsigned options) {
 | |
|   CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx;
 | |
|   if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing))
 | |
|     setThreadBackgroundPriority();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool hadError = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->Save(FileName);
 | |
|   return hadError ? CXSaveError_Unknown : CXSaveError_None;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_saveTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU, const char *FileName,
 | |
|                               unsigned options) {
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << TU << ' ' << FileName;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return CXSaveError_InvalidTU;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit->hasSema())
 | |
|     return CXSaveError_InvalidTU;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXSaveError result;
 | |
|   auto SaveTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result]() {
 | |
|     result = clang_saveTranslationUnit_Impl(TU, FileName, options);
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit->getDiagnostics().hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) {
 | |
|     SaveTranslationUnitImpl();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE"))
 | |
|       PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return result;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // We have an AST that has invalid nodes due to compiler errors.
 | |
|   // Use a crash recovery thread for protection.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!RunSafely(CRC, SaveTranslationUnitImpl)) {
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during AST saving: {\n");
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'filename' : '%s'\n", FileName);
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  'options' : %d,\n", options);
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "}\n");
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return CXSaveError_Unknown;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) {
 | |
|     PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) {
 | |
|   if (CTUnit) {
 | |
|     // If the translation unit has been marked as unsafe to free, just discard
 | |
|     // it.
 | |
|     ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
|     if (Unit && Unit->isUnsafeToFree())
 | |
|       return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     delete cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
|     delete CTUnit->StringPool;
 | |
|     delete static_cast<CXDiagnosticSetImpl *>(CTUnit->Diagnostics);
 | |
|     disposeOverridenCXCursorsPool(CTUnit->OverridenCursorsPool);
 | |
|     delete CTUnit->CommentToXML;
 | |
|     delete CTUnit;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_suspendTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) {
 | |
|   if (CTUnit) {
 | |
|     ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (Unit && Unit->isUnsafeToFree())
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     Unit->ResetForParse();
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_defaultReparseOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   return CXReparse_None;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXErrorCode
 | |
| clang_reparseTranslationUnit_Impl(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                   ArrayRef<CXUnsavedFile> unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                   unsigned options) {
 | |
|   // Check arguments.
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return CXError_InvalidArguments;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Reset the associated diagnostics.
 | |
|   delete static_cast<CXDiagnosticSetImpl*>(TU->Diagnostics);
 | |
|   TU->Diagnostics = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx;
 | |
|   if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing))
 | |
|     setThreadBackgroundPriority();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>> RemappedFiles(
 | |
|       new std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function.
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<
 | |
|     std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile> > RemappedCleanup(RemappedFiles.get());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (auto &UF : unsaved_files) {
 | |
|     std::unique_ptr<llvm::MemoryBuffer> MB =
 | |
|         llvm::MemoryBuffer::getMemBufferCopy(getContents(UF), UF.Filename);
 | |
|     RemappedFiles->push_back(std::make_pair(UF.Filename, MB.release()));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit->Reparse(CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations(),
 | |
|                         *RemappedFiles.get()))
 | |
|     return CXError_Success;
 | |
|   if (isASTReadError(CXXUnit))
 | |
|     return CXError_ASTReadError;
 | |
|   return CXError_Failure;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_reparseTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                  unsigned num_unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                  struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files,
 | |
|                                  unsigned options) {
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << TU;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (num_unsaved_files && !unsaved_files)
 | |
|     return CXError_InvalidArguments;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXErrorCode result;
 | |
|   auto ReparseTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result]() {
 | |
|     result = clang_reparseTranslationUnit_Impl(
 | |
|         TU, llvm::makeArrayRef(unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files), options);
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!RunSafely(CRC, ReparseTranslationUnitImpl)) {
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during reparsing\n");
 | |
|     cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->setUnsafeToFree(true);
 | |
|     return CXError_Crashed;
 | |
|   } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE"))
 | |
|     PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getTranslationUnitSpelling(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(CTUnit)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(CTUnit);
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(CXXUnit->getOriginalSourceFileName());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getTranslationUnitCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   return MakeCXCursor(CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl(), TU);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTargetInfo clang_getTranslationUnitTargetInfo(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(CTUnit)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(CTUnit);
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTargetInfoImpl* impl = new CXTargetInfoImpl();
 | |
|   impl->TranslationUnit = CTUnit;
 | |
|   return impl;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_TargetInfo_getTriple(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) {
 | |
|   if (!TargetInfo)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit CTUnit = TargetInfo->TranslationUnit;
 | |
|   assert(!isNotUsableTU(CTUnit) &&
 | |
|          "Unexpected unusable translation unit in TargetInfo");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
|   std::string Triple =
 | |
|     CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getTriple().normalize();
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(Triple);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_TargetInfo_getPointerWidth(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) {
 | |
|   if (!TargetInfo)
 | |
|     return -1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit CTUnit = TargetInfo->TranslationUnit;
 | |
|   assert(!isNotUsableTU(CTUnit) &&
 | |
|          "Unexpected unusable translation unit in TargetInfo");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit);
 | |
|   return CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getMaxPointerWidth();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_TargetInfo_dispose(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) {
 | |
|   if (!TargetInfo)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   delete TargetInfo;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // CXFile Operations.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getFileName(CXFile SFile) {
 | |
|   if (!SFile)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createRef(FEnt->getName());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| time_t clang_getFileTime(CXFile SFile) {
 | |
|   if (!SFile)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile);
 | |
|   return FEnt->getModificationTime();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXFile clang_getFile(CXTranslationUnit TU, const char *file_name) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileManager &FMgr = CXXUnit->getFileManager();
 | |
|   auto File = FMgr.getFile(file_name);
 | |
|   if (!File)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   return const_cast<FileEntry *>(*File);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const char *clang_getFileContents(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile file,
 | |
|                                   size_t *size) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const SourceManager &SM = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   FileID fid = SM.translateFile(static_cast<FileEntry *>(file));
 | |
|   bool Invalid = true;
 | |
|   const llvm::MemoryBuffer *buf = SM.getBuffer(fid, &Invalid);
 | |
|   if (Invalid) {
 | |
|     if (size)
 | |
|       *size = 0;
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (size)
 | |
|     *size = buf->getBufferSize();
 | |
|   return buf->getBufferStart();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                             CXFile file) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!file)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file);
 | |
|   return CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getHeaderSearchInfo()
 | |
|                                           .isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FEnt);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_getFileUniqueID(CXFile file, CXFileUniqueID *outID) {
 | |
|   if (!file || !outID)
 | |
|     return 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file);
 | |
|   const llvm::sys::fs::UniqueID &ID = FEnt->getUniqueID();
 | |
|   outID->data[0] = ID.getDevice();
 | |
|   outID->data[1] = ID.getFile();
 | |
|   outID->data[2] = FEnt->getModificationTime();
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_File_isEqual(CXFile file1, CXFile file2) {
 | |
|   if (file1 == file2)
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!file1 || !file2)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt1 = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file1);
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt2 = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file2);
 | |
|   return FEnt1->getUniqueID() == FEnt2->getUniqueID();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_File_tryGetRealPathName(CXFile SFile) {
 | |
|   if (!SFile)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createRef(FEnt->tryGetRealPathName());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // CXCursor Operations.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const Decl *getDeclFromExpr(const Stmt *E) {
 | |
|   if (const ImplicitCastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return getDeclFromExpr(CE->getSubExpr());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const DeclRefExpr *RefExpr = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return RefExpr->getDecl();
 | |
|   if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return ME->getMemberDecl();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *RE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return RE->getDecl();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E)) {
 | |
|     if (PRE->isExplicitProperty())
 | |
|       return PRE->getExplicitProperty();
 | |
|     // It could be messaging both getter and setter as in:
 | |
|     // ++myobj.myprop;
 | |
|     // in which case prefer to associate the setter since it is less obvious
 | |
|     // from inspecting the source that the setter is going to get called.
 | |
|     if (PRE->isMessagingSetter())
 | |
|       return PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter();
 | |
|     return PRE->getImplicitPropertyGetter();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (const PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return getDeclFromExpr(POE->getSyntacticForm());
 | |
|   if (const OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E))
 | |
|     if (Expr *Src = OVE->getSourceExpr())
 | |
|       return getDeclFromExpr(Src);
 | |
|       
 | |
|   if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return getDeclFromExpr(CE->getCallee());
 | |
|   if (const CXXConstructExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(E))
 | |
|     if (!CE->isElidable())
 | |
|     return CE->getConstructor();
 | |
|   if (const CXXInheritedCtorInitExpr *CE =
 | |
|           dyn_cast<CXXInheritedCtorInitExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return CE->getConstructor();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMessageExpr *OME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return OME->getMethodDecl();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const ObjCProtocolExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return PE->getProtocol();
 | |
|   if (const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr *NTTP
 | |
|                               = dyn_cast<SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return NTTP->getParameterPack();
 | |
|   if (const SizeOfPackExpr *SizeOfPack = dyn_cast<SizeOfPackExpr>(E))
 | |
|     if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(SizeOfPack->getPack()) || 
 | |
|         isa<ParmVarDecl>(SizeOfPack->getPack()))
 | |
|       return SizeOfPack->getPack();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static SourceLocation getLocationFromExpr(const Expr *E) {
 | |
|   if (const ImplicitCastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return getLocationFromExpr(CE->getSubExpr());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMessageExpr *Msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return /*FIXME:*/Msg->getLeftLoc();
 | |
|   if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return DRE->getLocation();
 | |
|   if (const MemberExpr *Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return Member->getMemberLoc();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return Ivar->getLocation();
 | |
|   if (const SizeOfPackExpr *SizeOfPack = dyn_cast<SizeOfPackExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return SizeOfPack->getPackLoc();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PropRef = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E))
 | |
|     return PropRef->getLocation();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return E->getBeginLoc();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| extern "C" {
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_visitChildren(CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                              CXCursorVisitor visitor,
 | |
|                              CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   CursorVisitor CursorVis(getCursorTU(parent), visitor, client_data,
 | |
|                           /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/false);
 | |
|   return CursorVis.VisitChildren(parent);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifndef __has_feature
 | |
| #define __has_feature(x) 0
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| #if __has_feature(blocks)
 | |
| typedef enum CXChildVisitResult 
 | |
|      (^CXCursorVisitorBlock)(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static enum CXChildVisitResult visitWithBlock(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent,
 | |
|     CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   CXCursorVisitorBlock block = (CXCursorVisitorBlock)client_data;
 | |
|   return block(cursor, parent);
 | |
| }
 | |
| #else
 | |
| // If we are compiled with a compiler that doesn't have native blocks support,
 | |
| // define and call the block manually, so the 
 | |
| typedef struct _CXChildVisitResult
 | |
| {
 | |
| 	void *isa;
 | |
| 	int flags;
 | |
| 	int reserved;
 | |
| 	enum CXChildVisitResult(*invoke)(struct _CXChildVisitResult*, CXCursor,
 | |
|                                          CXCursor);
 | |
| } *CXCursorVisitorBlock;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static enum CXChildVisitResult visitWithBlock(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent,
 | |
|     CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   CXCursorVisitorBlock block = (CXCursorVisitorBlock)client_data;
 | |
|   return block->invoke(block, cursor, parent);
 | |
| }
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_visitChildrenWithBlock(CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                                       CXCursorVisitorBlock block) {
 | |
|   return clang_visitChildren(parent, visitWithBlock, block);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXString getDeclSpelling(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D);
 | |
|   if (!ND) {
 | |
|     if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImpl =
 | |
|             dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = PropImpl->getPropertyDecl())
 | |
|         return cxstring::createDup(Property->getIdentifier()->getName());
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (const ImportDecl *ImportD = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (Module *Mod = ImportD->getImportedModule())
 | |
|         return cxstring::createDup(Mod->getFullModuleName());
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(ND))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(OMD->getSelector().getAsString());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CIMP = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ND))
 | |
|     // No, this isn't the same as the code below. getIdentifier() is non-virtual
 | |
|     // and returns different names. NamedDecl returns the class name and
 | |
|     // ObjCCategoryImplDecl returns the category name.
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(CIMP->getIdentifier()->getNameStart());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isa<UsingDirectiveDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   SmallString<1024> S;
 | |
|   llvm::raw_svector_ostream os(S);
 | |
|   ND->printName(os);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(os.str());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getCursorSpelling(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isTranslationUnit(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getTranslationUnitSpelling(getCursorTU(C));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     switch (C.kind) {
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: {
 | |
|       const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Super = getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).first;
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef(Super->getIdentifier()->getNameStart());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: {
 | |
|       const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = getCursorObjCClassRef(C).first;
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef(Class->getIdentifier()->getNameStart());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: {
 | |
|       const ObjCProtocolDecl *OID = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(OID && "getCursorSpelling(): Missing protocol decl");
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef(OID->getIdentifier()->getNameStart());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: {
 | |
|       const CXXBaseSpecifier *B = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C);
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(B->getType().getAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TypeRef: {
 | |
|       const TypeDecl *Type = getCursorTypeRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(Type && "Missing type decl");
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(getCursorContext(C).getTypeDeclType(Type).
 | |
|                               getAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TemplateRef: {
 | |
|       const TemplateDecl *Template = getCursorTemplateRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(Template && "Missing template decl");
 | |
|       
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(Template->getNameAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|         
 | |
|     case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: {
 | |
|       const NamedDecl *NS = getCursorNamespaceRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(NS && "Missing namespace decl");
 | |
|       
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(NS->getNameAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_MemberRef: {
 | |
|       const FieldDecl *Field = getCursorMemberRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(Field && "Missing member decl");
 | |
|       
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(Field->getNameAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_LabelRef: {
 | |
|       const LabelStmt *Label = getCursorLabelRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(Label && "Missing label");
 | |
|       
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef(Label->getName());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: {
 | |
|       OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).first;
 | |
|       if (const Decl *D = Storage.dyn_cast<const Decl *>()) {
 | |
|         if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D))
 | |
|           return cxstring::createDup(ND->getNameAsString());
 | |
|         return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>())
 | |
|         return cxstring::createDup(E->getName().getAsString());
 | |
|       OverloadedTemplateStorage *Ovl
 | |
|         = Storage.get<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>();
 | |
|       if (Ovl->size() == 0)
 | |
|         return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup((*Ovl->begin())->getNameAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|         
 | |
|     case CXCursor_VariableRef: {
 | |
|       const VarDecl *Var = getCursorVariableRef(C).first;
 | |
|       assert(Var && "Missing variable decl");
 | |
|       
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(Var->getNameAsString());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|         
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("<not implemented>");
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCStringLiteral ||
 | |
|         C.kind == CXCursor_StringLiteral) {
 | |
|       const StringLiteral *SLit;
 | |
|       if (const ObjCStringLiteral *OSL = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(E)) {
 | |
|         SLit = OSL->getString();
 | |
|       } else {
 | |
|         SLit = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       SmallString<256> Buf;
 | |
|       llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Buf);
 | |
|       SLit->outputString(OS);
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(OS.str());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     const Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(getCursorExpr(C));
 | |
|     if (D)
 | |
|       return getDeclSpelling(D);
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C);
 | |
|     if (const LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast_or_null<LabelStmt>(S))
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef(Label->getName());
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getName()
 | |
|                                                            ->getNameStart());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getName()
 | |
|                                                            ->getNameStart());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getFileName());
 | |
|       
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return getDeclSpelling(getCursorDecl(C));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_AnnotateAttr) {
 | |
|     const AnnotateAttr *AA = cast<AnnotateAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C));
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(AA->getAnnotation());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr) {
 | |
|     const AsmLabelAttr *AA = cast<AsmLabelAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C));
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(AA->getLabel());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_PackedAttr) {
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("packed");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_VisibilityAttr) {
 | |
|     const VisibilityAttr *AA = cast<VisibilityAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C));
 | |
|     switch (AA->getVisibility()) {
 | |
|     case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Default:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("default");
 | |
|     case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Hidden:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("hidden");
 | |
|     case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Protected:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("protected");
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     llvm_unreachable("unknown visibility type");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getSpellingNameRange(CXCursor C,
 | |
|                                                 unsigned pieceIndex,
 | |
|                                                 unsigned options) {
 | |
|   if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = getCursorContext(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C);
 | |
|     if (const LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast_or_null<LabelStmt>(S)) {
 | |
|       if (pieceIndex > 0)
 | |
|         return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, Label->getIdentLoc());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCMessageExpr) {
 | |
|     if (const ObjCMessageExpr *
 | |
|           ME = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMessageExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) {
 | |
|       if (pieceIndex >= ME->getNumSelectorLocs())
 | |
|         return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, ME->getSelectorLoc(pieceIndex));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl ||
 | |
|       C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) {
 | |
|     if (const ObjCMethodDecl *
 | |
|           MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) {
 | |
|       if (pieceIndex >= MD->getNumSelectorLocs())
 | |
|         return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, MD->getSelectorLoc(pieceIndex));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCCategoryDecl ||
 | |
|       C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCCategoryImplDecl) {
 | |
|     if (pieceIndex > 0)
 | |
|       return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|     if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *
 | |
|           CD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCCategoryDecl>(getCursorDecl(C)))
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, CD->getCategoryNameLoc());
 | |
|     if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *
 | |
|           CID = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(getCursorDecl(C)))
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, CID->getCategoryNameLoc());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl) {
 | |
|     if (pieceIndex > 0)
 | |
|       return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|     if (const ImportDecl *ImportD =
 | |
|             dyn_cast_or_null<ImportDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) {
 | |
|       ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs = ImportD->getIdentifierLocs();
 | |
|       if (!Locs.empty())
 | |
|         return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx,
 | |
|                                          SourceRange(Locs.front(), Locs.back()));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_CXXMethod || C.kind == CXCursor_Destructor ||
 | |
|       C.kind == CXCursor_ConversionFunction ||
 | |
|       C.kind == CXCursor_FunctionDecl) {
 | |
|     if (pieceIndex > 0)
 | |
|       return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|     if (const FunctionDecl *FD =
 | |
|             dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) {
 | |
|       DeclarationNameInfo FunctionName = FD->getNameInfo();
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, FunctionName.getSourceRange());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: A CXCursor_InclusionDirective should give the location of the
 | |
|   // filename, but we don't keep track of this.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: A CXCursor_AnnotateAttr should give the location of the annotation
 | |
|   // but we don't keep track of this.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: A CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr should give the location of the label
 | |
|   // but we don't keep track of this.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Default handling, give the location of the cursor.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (pieceIndex > 0)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXSourceLocation CXLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(C);
 | |
|   SourceLocation Loc = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(CXLoc);
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, Loc);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Cursor_getMangling(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Mangling only works for functions and variables.
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!D || !(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D)))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext();
 | |
|   ASTNameGenerator ASTNameGen(Ctx);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(ASTNameGen.getName(D));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXStringSet *clang_Cursor_getCXXManglings(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!(isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D) || isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D)))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext();
 | |
|   ASTNameGenerator ASTNameGen(Ctx);
 | |
|   std::vector<std::string> Manglings = ASTNameGen.getAllManglings(D);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createSet(Manglings);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXStringSet *clang_Cursor_getObjCManglings(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!(isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCImplementationDecl>(D)))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext();
 | |
|   ASTNameGenerator ASTNameGen(Ctx);
 | |
|   std::vector<std::string> Manglings = ASTNameGen.getAllManglings(D);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createSet(Manglings);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXPrintingPolicy clang_getCursorPrintingPolicy(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   return new PrintingPolicy(getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_PrintingPolicy_dispose(CXPrintingPolicy Policy) {
 | |
|   if (Policy)
 | |
|     delete static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned
 | |
| clang_PrintingPolicy_getProperty(CXPrintingPolicy Policy,
 | |
|                                  enum CXPrintingPolicyProperty Property) {
 | |
|   if (!Policy)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PrintingPolicy *P = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy);
 | |
|   switch (Property) {
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Indentation:
 | |
|     return P->Indentation;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressSpecifiers:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressSpecifiers;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTagKeyword:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressTagKeyword;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeTagDefinition:
 | |
|     return P->IncludeTagDefinition;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressScope:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressScope;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressUnwrittenScope:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressUnwrittenScope;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressInitializers:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressInitializers;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantArraySizeAsWritten:
 | |
|     return P->ConstantArraySizeAsWritten;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_AnonymousTagLocations:
 | |
|     return P->AnonymousTagLocations;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressStrongLifetime:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressStrongLifetime;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressLifetimeQualifiers:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressLifetimeQualifiers;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Bool:
 | |
|     return P->Bool;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Restrict:
 | |
|     return P->Restrict;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Alignof:
 | |
|     return P->Alignof;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_UnderscoreAlignof:
 | |
|     return P->UnderscoreAlignof;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_UseVoidForZeroParams:
 | |
|     return P->UseVoidForZeroParams;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_TerseOutput:
 | |
|     return P->TerseOutput;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_PolishForDeclaration:
 | |
|     return P->PolishForDeclaration;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Half:
 | |
|     return P->Half;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_MSWChar:
 | |
|     return P->MSWChar;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeNewlines:
 | |
|     return P->IncludeNewlines;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_MSVCFormatting:
 | |
|     return P->MSVCFormatting;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantsAsWritten:
 | |
|     return P->ConstantsAsWritten;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressImplicitBase:
 | |
|     return P->SuppressImplicitBase;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_FullyQualifiedName:
 | |
|     return P->FullyQualifiedName;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   assert(false && "Invalid CXPrintingPolicyProperty");
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_PrintingPolicy_setProperty(CXPrintingPolicy Policy,
 | |
|                                       enum CXPrintingPolicyProperty Property,
 | |
|                                       unsigned Value) {
 | |
|   if (!Policy)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PrintingPolicy *P = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy);
 | |
|   switch (Property) {
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Indentation:
 | |
|     P->Indentation = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressSpecifiers:
 | |
|     P->SuppressSpecifiers = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTagKeyword:
 | |
|     P->SuppressTagKeyword = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeTagDefinition:
 | |
|     P->IncludeTagDefinition = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressScope:
 | |
|     P->SuppressScope = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressUnwrittenScope:
 | |
|     P->SuppressUnwrittenScope = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressInitializers:
 | |
|     P->SuppressInitializers = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantArraySizeAsWritten:
 | |
|     P->ConstantArraySizeAsWritten = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_AnonymousTagLocations:
 | |
|     P->AnonymousTagLocations = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressStrongLifetime:
 | |
|     P->SuppressStrongLifetime = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressLifetimeQualifiers:
 | |
|     P->SuppressLifetimeQualifiers = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors:
 | |
|     P->SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Bool:
 | |
|     P->Bool = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Restrict:
 | |
|     P->Restrict = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Alignof:
 | |
|     P->Alignof = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_UnderscoreAlignof:
 | |
|     P->UnderscoreAlignof = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_UseVoidForZeroParams:
 | |
|     P->UseVoidForZeroParams = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_TerseOutput:
 | |
|     P->TerseOutput = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_PolishForDeclaration:
 | |
|     P->PolishForDeclaration = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_Half:
 | |
|     P->Half = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_MSWChar:
 | |
|     P->MSWChar = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeNewlines:
 | |
|     P->IncludeNewlines = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_MSVCFormatting:
 | |
|     P->MSVCFormatting = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantsAsWritten:
 | |
|     P->ConstantsAsWritten = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressImplicitBase:
 | |
|     P->SuppressImplicitBase = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   case CXPrintingPolicy_FullyQualifiedName:
 | |
|     P->FullyQualifiedName = Value;
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   assert(false && "Invalid CXPrintingPolicyProperty");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getCursorPrettyPrinted(CXCursor C, CXPrintingPolicy cxPolicy) {
 | |
|   if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|     if (!D)
 | |
|       return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SmallString<128> Str;
 | |
|     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
 | |
|     PrintingPolicy *UserPolicy = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(cxPolicy);
 | |
|     D->print(OS, UserPolicy ? *UserPolicy
 | |
|                             : getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy());
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(OS.str());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getCursorDisplayName(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getCursorSpelling(C);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PrintingPolicy Policy = getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy();
 | |
|   if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
 | |
|     D = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (const FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     SmallString<64> Str;
 | |
|     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
 | |
|     OS << *Function;
 | |
|     if (Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
 | |
|       OS << "<>";
 | |
|     OS << "(";
 | |
|     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Function->getNumParams(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|       if (I)
 | |
|         OS << ", ";
 | |
|       OS << Function->getParamDecl(I)->getType().getAsString(Policy);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (Function->isVariadic()) {
 | |
|       if (Function->getNumParams())
 | |
|         OS << ", ";
 | |
|       OS << "...";
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     OS << ")";
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(OS.str());
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (const ClassTemplateDecl *ClassTemplate = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     SmallString<64> Str;
 | |
|     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
 | |
|     OS << *ClassTemplate;
 | |
|     OS << "<";
 | |
|     TemplateParameterList *Params = ClassTemplate->getTemplateParameters();
 | |
|     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Params->size(); I != N; ++I) {
 | |
|       if (I)
 | |
|         OS << ", ";
 | |
|       
 | |
|       NamedDecl *Param = Params->getParam(I);
 | |
|       if (Param->getIdentifier()) {
 | |
|         OS << Param->getIdentifier()->getName();
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       
 | |
|       // There is no parameter name, which makes this tricky. Try to come up
 | |
|       // with something useful that isn't too long.
 | |
|       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param))
 | |
|         if (const auto *TC = TTP->getTypeConstraint()) {
 | |
|           TC->getConceptNameInfo().printName(OS, Policy);
 | |
|           if (TC->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
 | |
|             OS << "<...>";
 | |
|         } else
 | |
|           OS << (TTP->wasDeclaredWithTypename()? "typename" : "class");
 | |
|       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
 | |
|                                     = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param))
 | |
|         OS << NTTP->getType().getAsString(Policy);
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         OS << "template<...> class";
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     OS << ">";
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(OS.str());
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassSpec
 | |
|                               = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     // If the type was explicitly written, use that.
 | |
|     if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ClassSpec->getTypeAsWritten())
 | |
|       return cxstring::createDup(TSInfo->getType().getAsString(Policy));
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SmallString<128> Str;
 | |
|     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
 | |
|     OS << *ClassSpec;
 | |
|     printTemplateArgumentList(OS, ClassSpec->getTemplateArgs().asArray(),
 | |
|                               Policy);
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(OS.str());
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return clang_getCursorSpelling(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
|   
 | |
| CXString clang_getCursorKindSpelling(enum CXCursorKind Kind) {
 | |
|   switch (Kind) {
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FunctionDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("FunctionDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TypedefDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("TypedefDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_EnumDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("EnumDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_EnumConstantDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("EnumConstantDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_StructDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("StructDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnionDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnionDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ClassDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ClassDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FieldDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("FieldDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_VarDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("VarDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ParmDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ParmDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCInterfaceDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCCategoryDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCCategoryDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCPropertyDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCIvarDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCIvarDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCInstanceMethodDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCClassMethodDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCImplementationDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCImplementationDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCCategoryImplDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCCategoryImplDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXMethod:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXMethod");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnexposedDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSuperClassRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCClassRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TypeRef:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("TypeRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TemplateRef:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("TemplateRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NamespaceRef:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("NamespaceRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MemberRef:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("MemberRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_LabelRef:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("LabelRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OverloadedDeclRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_VariableRef:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("VariableRef");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IntegerLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("IntegerLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FixedPointLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("FixedPointLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FloatingLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("FloatingLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ImaginaryLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ImaginaryLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_StringLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("StringLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CharacterLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CharacterLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ParenExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ParenExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnaryOperator:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnaryOperator");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ArraySubscriptExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ArraySubscriptExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPArraySectionExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("OMPArraySectionExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_BinaryOperator:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("BinaryOperator");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CompoundAssignOperator:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CompoundAssignOperator");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ConditionalOperator:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ConditionalOperator");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CStyleCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CStyleCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CompoundLiteralExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CompoundLiteralExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_InitListExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("InitListExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_AddrLabelExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("AddrLabelExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_StmtExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("StmtExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_GenericSelectionExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("GenericSelectionExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_GNUNullExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("GNUNullExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXStaticCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXStaticCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXDynamicCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXDynamicCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXReinterpretCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXReinterpretCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXConstCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXConstCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXFunctionalCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXFunctionalCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXTypeidExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXTypeidExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXBoolLiteralExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXBoolLiteralExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXThisExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXThisExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXThrowExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXThrowExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXNewExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXNewExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXDeleteExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXDeleteExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnaryExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnaryExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCStringLiteral:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCStringLiteral");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCBoolLiteralExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCBoolLiteralExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCSelfExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSelfExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCEncodeExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCEncodeExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCSelectorExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSelectorExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCBridgedCastExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCBridgedCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_BlockExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("BlockExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_PackExpansionExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("PackExpansionExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SizeOfPackExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SizeOfPackExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_LambdaExpr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("LambdaExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnexposedExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DeclRefExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("DeclRefExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MemberRefExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("MemberRefExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CallExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CallExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCMessageExpr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCMessageExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_BuiltinBitCastExpr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("BuiltinBitCastExpr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnexposedStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DeclStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("DeclStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_LabelStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("LabelStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CompoundStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CompoundStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CaseStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CaseStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DefaultStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("DefaultStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IfStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("IfStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SwitchStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SwitchStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_WhileStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("WhileStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DoStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("DoStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ForStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ForStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_GotoStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("GotoStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IndirectGotoStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("IndirectGotoStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ContinueStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ContinueStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_BreakStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("BreakStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ReturnStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ReturnStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_GCCAsmStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("GCCAsmStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MSAsmStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("MSAsmStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAtTryStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtTryStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAtCatchStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtCatchStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAtFinallyStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtFinallyStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAtThrowStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtThrowStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAtSynchronizedStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtSynchronizedStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCForCollectionStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("ObjCForCollectionStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXCatchStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXCatchStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXTryStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXTryStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXForRangeStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("CXXForRangeStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SEHTryStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SEHTryStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SEHExceptStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SEHExceptStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SEHFinallyStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SEHFinallyStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_SEHLeaveStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("SEHLeaveStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NullStmt:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("NullStmt");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_InvalidFile:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("InvalidFile");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_InvalidCode:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("InvalidCode");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NoDeclFound:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("NoDeclFound");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NotImplemented:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("NotImplemented");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TranslationUnit:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("TranslationUnit");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UnexposedAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedAttr");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IBActionAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ibaction)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IBOutletAttr:
 | |
|      return cxstring::createRef("attribute(iboutlet)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(iboutletcollection)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXFinalAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(final)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXOverrideAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(override)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_AnnotateAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(annotate)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("asm label");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_PackedAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(packed)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_PureAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(pure)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ConstAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(const)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NoDuplicateAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(noduplicate)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CUDAConstantAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(constant)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CUDADeviceAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(device)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CUDAGlobalAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(global)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CUDAHostAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(host)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CUDASharedAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(shared)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_VisibilityAttr:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(visibility)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DLLExport:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(dllexport)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DLLImport:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(dllimport)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NSReturnsRetained:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ns_returns_retained)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NSReturnsNotRetained:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ns_returns_not_retained)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NSReturnsAutoreleased:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ns_returns_autoreleased)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NSConsumesSelf:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ns_consumes_self)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NSConsumed:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ns_consumed)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCException:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_exception)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCNSObject:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(NSObject)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCIndependentClass:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_independent_class)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCPreciseLifetime:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_precise_lifetime)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCReturnsInnerPointer:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_returns_inner_pointer)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCRequiresSuper:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_requires_super)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCRootClass:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_root_class)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCSubclassingRestricted:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_subclassing_restricted)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCExplicitProtocolImpl:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_protocol_requires_explicit_implementation)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCDesignatedInitializer:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_designated_initializer)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCRuntimeVisible:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_runtime_visible)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCBoxable:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(objc_boxable)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FlagEnum:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("attribute(flag_enum)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("preprocessing directive");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MacroDefinition:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("macro definition");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MacroExpansion:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("macro expansion");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_InclusionDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("inclusion directive");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_Namespace:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("Namespace");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_LinkageSpec:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("LinkageSpec");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("C++ base class specifier");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_Constructor:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("CXXConstructor");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_Destructor:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("CXXDestructor");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ConversionFunction:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("CXXConversion");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TemplateTypeParameter:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("TemplateTypeParameter");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NonTypeTemplateParameter:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("NonTypeTemplateParameter");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TemplateTemplateParameter:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("TemplateTemplateParameter");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FunctionTemplate:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("FunctionTemplate");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ClassTemplate:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("ClassTemplate");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_NamespaceAlias:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("NamespaceAlias");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UsingDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("UsingDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_UsingDeclaration:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("UsingDeclaration");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TypeAliasDecl:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("TypeAliasDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCSynthesizeDecl:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSynthesizeDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ObjCDynamicDecl:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("ObjCDynamicDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CXXAccessSpecifier:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("CXXAccessSpecifier");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("ModuleImport");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPSectionsDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPSectionsDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPSectionDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPSectionDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPSingleDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPSingleDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPMasterDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPMasterDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPCriticalDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPCriticalDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelMasterDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelMasterDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelSectionsDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelSectionsDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskyieldDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskyieldDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPBarrierDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPBarrierDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskwaitDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskwaitDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskgroupDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskgroupDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPFlushDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPFlushDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPDepobjDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPDepobjDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPOrderedDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPOrderedDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPAtomicDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPAtomicDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetDataDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetDataDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetEnterDataDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetEnterDataDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetExitDataDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetExitDataDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetUpdateDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetUpdateDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPCancellationPointDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPCancellationPointDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPCancelDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPCancelDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskLoopDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskLoopDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPMasterTaskLoopDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPMasterTaskLoopDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelMasterTaskLoopSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPDistributeDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPDistributeParallelForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeParallelForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPDistributeSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(
 | |
|         "OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective:
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_OverloadCandidate:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("OverloadCandidate");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_TypeAliasTemplateDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("TypeAliasTemplateDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_StaticAssert:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("StaticAssert");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_FriendDecl:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("FriendDecl");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_ConvergentAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(convergent)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_WarnUnusedAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(warn_unused)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_WarnUnusedResultAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(warn_unused_result)");
 | |
|   case CXCursor_AlignedAttr:
 | |
|       return cxstring::createRef("attribute(aligned)");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled CXCursorKind");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| struct GetCursorData {
 | |
|   SourceLocation TokenBeginLoc;
 | |
|   bool PointsAtMacroArgExpansion;
 | |
|   bool VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl;
 | |
|   SourceLocation VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc;
 | |
|   CXCursor &BestCursor;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   GetCursorData(SourceManager &SM,
 | |
|                 SourceLocation tokenBegin, CXCursor &outputCursor)
 | |
|     : TokenBeginLoc(tokenBegin), BestCursor(outputCursor) {
 | |
|     PointsAtMacroArgExpansion = SM.isMacroArgExpansion(tokenBegin);
 | |
|     VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl = false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| static enum CXChildVisitResult GetCursorVisitor(CXCursor cursor,
 | |
|                                                 CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                                                 CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   GetCursorData *Data = static_cast<GetCursorData *>(client_data);
 | |
|   CXCursor *BestCursor = &Data->BestCursor;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If we point inside a macro argument we should provide info of what the
 | |
|   // token is so use the actual cursor, don't replace it with a macro expansion
 | |
|   // cursor.
 | |
|   if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion && Data->PointsAtMacroArgExpansion)
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     // Avoid having the implicit methods override the property decls.
 | |
|     if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD
 | |
|           = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|       if (MD->isImplicit())
 | |
|         return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     } else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID
 | |
|                  = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|       // Check that when we have multiple @class references in the same line,
 | |
|       // that later ones do not override the previous ones.
 | |
|       // If we have:
 | |
|       // @class Foo, Bar;
 | |
|       // source ranges for both start at '@', so 'Bar' will end up overriding
 | |
|       // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'.
 | |
|       if (BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl ||
 | |
|           BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassRef)
 | |
|         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevID
 | |
|              = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(getCursorDecl(*BestCursor))){
 | |
|          if (PrevID != ID &&
 | |
|              !PrevID->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
 | |
|              !ID->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|            return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     } else if (const DeclaratorDecl *DD
 | |
|                     = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclaratorDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|       SourceLocation StartLoc = DD->getSourceRange().getBegin();
 | |
|       // Check that when we have multiple declarators in the same line,
 | |
|       // that later ones do not override the previous ones.
 | |
|       // If we have:
 | |
|       // int Foo, Bar;
 | |
|       // source ranges for both start at 'int', so 'Bar' will end up overriding
 | |
|       // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'.
 | |
|       if (Data->VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc == StartLoc)
 | |
|         return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
|       Data->VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc = StartLoc;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     } else if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImp
 | |
|               = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|       (void)PropImp;
 | |
|       // Check that when we have multiple @synthesize in the same line,
 | |
|       // that later ones do not override the previous ones.
 | |
|       // If we have:
 | |
|       // @synthesize Foo, Bar;
 | |
|       // source ranges for both start at '@', so 'Bar' will end up overriding
 | |
|       // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'.
 | |
|       if (Data->VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl)
 | |
|         return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
|       Data->VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl = true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(cursor.kind) &&
 | |
|       clang_isDeclaration(BestCursor->kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(*BestCursor)) {
 | |
|       // Avoid having the cursor of an expression replace the declaration cursor
 | |
|       // when the expression source range overlaps the declaration range.
 | |
|       // This can happen for C++ constructor expressions whose range generally
 | |
|       // include the variable declaration, e.g.:
 | |
|       //  MyCXXClass foo; // Make sure pointing at 'foo' returns a VarDecl cursor.
 | |
|       if (D->getLocation().isValid() && Data->TokenBeginLoc.isValid() &&
 | |
|           D->getLocation() == Data->TokenBeginLoc)
 | |
|         return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If our current best cursor is the construction of a temporary object, 
 | |
|   // don't replace that cursor with a type reference, because we want 
 | |
|   // clang_getCursor() to point at the constructor.
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(BestCursor->kind) &&
 | |
|       isa<CXXTemporaryObjectExpr>(getCursorExpr(*BestCursor)) &&
 | |
|       cursor.kind == CXCursor_TypeRef) {
 | |
|     // Keep the cursor pointing at CXXTemporaryObjectExpr but also mark it
 | |
|     // as having the actual point on the type reference.
 | |
|     *BestCursor = getTypeRefedCallExprCursor(*BestCursor);
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If we already have an Objective-C superclass reference, don't
 | |
|   // update it further.
 | |
|   if (BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef)
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *BestCursor = cursor;
 | |
|   return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceLocation Loc) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation SLoc = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(Loc);
 | |
|   CXCursor Result = cxcursor::getCursor(TU, SLoc);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     CXFile SearchFile;
 | |
|     unsigned SearchLine, SearchColumn;
 | |
|     CXFile ResultFile;
 | |
|     unsigned ResultLine, ResultColumn;
 | |
|     CXString SearchFileName, ResultFileName, KindSpelling, USR;
 | |
|     const char *IsDef = clang_isCursorDefinition(Result)? " (Definition)" : "";
 | |
|     CXSourceLocation ResultLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(Result);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     clang_getFileLocation(Loc, &SearchFile, &SearchLine, &SearchColumn,
 | |
|                           nullptr);
 | |
|     clang_getFileLocation(ResultLoc, &ResultFile, &ResultLine,
 | |
|                           &ResultColumn, nullptr);
 | |
|     SearchFileName = clang_getFileName(SearchFile);
 | |
|     ResultFileName = clang_getFileName(ResultFile);
 | |
|     KindSpelling = clang_getCursorKindSpelling(Result.kind);
 | |
|     USR = clang_getCursorUSR(Result);
 | |
|     *Log << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d) = %s",
 | |
|                    clang_getCString(SearchFileName), SearchLine, SearchColumn,
 | |
|                    clang_getCString(KindSpelling))
 | |
|         << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d):%s%s",
 | |
|                      clang_getCString(ResultFileName), ResultLine, ResultColumn,
 | |
|                      clang_getCString(USR), IsDef);
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(SearchFileName);
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(ResultFileName);
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(KindSpelling);
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(USR);
 | |
|     
 | |
|     CXCursor Definition = clang_getCursorDefinition(Result);
 | |
|     if (!clang_equalCursors(Definition, clang_getNullCursor())) {
 | |
|       CXSourceLocation DefinitionLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(Definition);
 | |
|       CXString DefinitionKindSpelling
 | |
|                                 = clang_getCursorKindSpelling(Definition.kind);
 | |
|       CXFile DefinitionFile;
 | |
|       unsigned DefinitionLine, DefinitionColumn;
 | |
|       clang_getFileLocation(DefinitionLoc, &DefinitionFile,
 | |
|                             &DefinitionLine, &DefinitionColumn, nullptr);
 | |
|       CXString DefinitionFileName = clang_getFileName(DefinitionFile);
 | |
|       *Log << llvm::format("  -> %s(%s:%d:%d)",
 | |
|                      clang_getCString(DefinitionKindSpelling),
 | |
|                      clang_getCString(DefinitionFileName),
 | |
|                      DefinitionLine, DefinitionColumn);
 | |
|       clang_disposeString(DefinitionFileName);
 | |
|       clang_disposeString(DefinitionKindSpelling);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getNullCursor(void) {
 | |
|   return MakeCXCursorInvalid(CXCursor_InvalidFile);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_equalCursors(CXCursor X, CXCursor Y) {
 | |
|   // Clear out the "FirstInDeclGroup" part in a declaration cursor, since we
 | |
|   // can't set consistently. For example, when visiting a DeclStmt we will set
 | |
|   // it but we don't set it on the result of clang_getCursorDefinition for
 | |
|   // a reference of the same declaration.
 | |
|   // FIXME: Setting "FirstInDeclGroup" in CXCursors is a hack that only works
 | |
|   // when visiting a DeclStmt currently, the AST should be enhanced to be able
 | |
|   // to provide that kind of info.
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(X.kind))
 | |
|     X.data[1] = nullptr;
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(Y.kind))
 | |
|     Y.data[1] = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return X == Y;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_hashCursor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   unsigned Index = 0;
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(C.kind) || clang_isStatement(C.kind))
 | |
|     Index = 1;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return llvm::DenseMapInfo<std::pair<unsigned, const void*> >::getHashValue(
 | |
|                                         std::make_pair(C.kind, C.data[Index]));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isInvalid(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K >= CXCursor_FirstInvalid && K <= CXCursor_LastInvalid;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isDeclaration(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return (K >= CXCursor_FirstDecl && K <= CXCursor_LastDecl) ||
 | |
|          (K >= CXCursor_FirstExtraDecl && K <= CXCursor_LastExtraDecl);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isInvalidDeclaration(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C))
 | |
|       return D->isInvalidDecl();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isReference(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K >= CXCursor_FirstRef && K <= CXCursor_LastRef;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isExpression(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K >= CXCursor_FirstExpr && K <= CXCursor_LastExpr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isStatement(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K >= CXCursor_FirstStmt && K <= CXCursor_LastStmt;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isAttribute(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|     return K >= CXCursor_FirstAttr && K <= CXCursor_LastAttr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isTranslationUnit(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K == CXCursor_TranslationUnit;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isPreprocessing(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   return K >= CXCursor_FirstPreprocessing && K <= CXCursor_LastPreprocessing;
 | |
| }
 | |
|   
 | |
| unsigned clang_isUnexposed(enum CXCursorKind K) {
 | |
|   switch (K) {
 | |
|     case CXCursor_UnexposedDecl:
 | |
|     case CXCursor_UnexposedExpr:
 | |
|     case CXCursor_UnexposedStmt:
 | |
|     case CXCursor_UnexposedAttr:
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       return false;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursorKind clang_getCursorKind(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   return C.kind;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceLocation clang_getCursorLocation(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     switch (C.kind) {
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, SourceLocation> P
 | |
|         = getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const ObjCProtocolDecl *, SourceLocation> P
 | |
|         = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, SourceLocation> P
 | |
|         = getCursorObjCClassRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TypeRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const TypeDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorTypeRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TemplateRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const TemplateDecl *, SourceLocation> P =
 | |
|           getCursorTemplateRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const NamedDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorNamespaceRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_MemberRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const FieldDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorMemberRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_VariableRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const VarDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorVariableRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: {
 | |
|       const CXXBaseSpecifier *BaseSpec = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C);
 | |
|       if (!BaseSpec)
 | |
|         return clang_getNullLocation();
 | |
|       
 | |
|       if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = BaseSpec->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|         return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C),
 | |
|                                             TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C),
 | |
|                                             BaseSpec->getBeginLoc());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_LabelRef: {
 | |
|       std::pair<const LabelStmt *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorLabelRef(C);
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), P.second);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef:
 | |
|       return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C),
 | |
|                                           getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).second);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       // FIXME: Need a way to enumerate all non-reference cases.
 | |
|       llvm_unreachable("Missed a reference kind");
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(C.kind))
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C),
 | |
|                                    getLocationFromExpr(getCursorExpr(C)));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(C.kind))
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C),
 | |
|                                           getCursorStmt(C)->getBeginLoc());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation L = cxcursor::getCursorPreprocessingDirective(C).getBegin();
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation L
 | |
|       = cxcursor::getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getSourceRange().getBegin();
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation L = cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getLocation();
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation L
 | |
|       = cxcursor::getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getSourceRange().getBegin();
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isAttribute(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation L
 | |
|       = cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)->getLocation();
 | |
|     return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullLocation();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullLocation();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation Loc = D->getLocation();
 | |
|   // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration
 | |
|   // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their
 | |
|   // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context
 | |
|   // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup,
 | |
|   // and if so, whether it is the first decl.
 | |
|   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C))
 | |
|       Loc = VD->getLocation();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // For ObjC methods, give the start location of the method name.
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|     Loc = MD->getSelectorStartLoc();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), Loc);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| } // end extern "C"
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor cxcursor::getCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU, SourceLocation SLoc) {
 | |
|   assert(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Guard against an invalid SourceLocation, or we may assert in one
 | |
|   // of the following calls.
 | |
|   if (SLoc.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Translate the given source location to make it point at the beginning of
 | |
|   // the token under the cursor.
 | |
|   SLoc = Lexer::GetBeginningOfToken(SLoc, CXXUnit->getSourceManager(),
 | |
|                                     CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   CXCursor Result = MakeCXCursorInvalid(CXCursor_NoDeclFound);
 | |
|   if (SLoc.isValid()) {
 | |
|     GetCursorData ResultData(CXXUnit->getSourceManager(), SLoc, Result);
 | |
|     CursorVisitor CursorVis(TU, GetCursorVisitor, &ResultData,
 | |
|                             /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true, 
 | |
|                             /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false,
 | |
|                             SourceLocation(SLoc));
 | |
|     CursorVis.visitFileRegion();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static SourceRange getRawCursorExtent(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     switch (C.kind) {
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef:
 | |
|       return  getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorObjCClassRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TypeRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorTypeRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TemplateRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorTemplateRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_NamespaceRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorNamespaceRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_MemberRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorMemberRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier:
 | |
|       return getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C)->getSourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_LabelRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorLabelRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).second;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_VariableRef:
 | |
|       return getCursorVariableRef(C).second;
 | |
|         
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       // FIXME: Need a way to enumerate all non-reference cases.
 | |
|       llvm_unreachable("Missed a reference kind");
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(C.kind))
 | |
|     return getCursorExpr(C)->getSourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(C.kind))
 | |
|     return getCursorStmt(C)->getSourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isAttribute(C.kind))
 | |
|     return getCursorAttr(C)->getRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective)
 | |
|     return cxcursor::getCursorPreprocessingDirective(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) {
 | |
|     ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getSourceRange();
 | |
|     return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) {
 | |
|     ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getSourceRange();
 | |
|     return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective) {
 | |
|     ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|     SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getSourceRange();
 | |
|     return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_TranslationUnit) {
 | |
|     ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C);
 | |
|     FileID MainID = TU->getSourceManager().getMainFileID();
 | |
|     SourceLocation Start = TU->getSourceManager().getLocForStartOfFile(MainID);
 | |
|     SourceLocation End = TU->getSourceManager().getLocForEndOfFile(MainID);
 | |
|     return SourceRange(Start, End);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|     if (!D)
 | |
|       return SourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceRange R = D->getSourceRange();
 | |
|     // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration
 | |
|     // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their
 | |
|     // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context
 | |
|     // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup,
 | |
|     // and if so, whether it is the first decl.
 | |
|     if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C))
 | |
|         R.setBegin(VD->getLocation());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     return R;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return SourceRange();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Retrieves the "raw" cursor extent, which is then extended to include
 | |
| /// the decl-specifier-seq for declarations.
 | |
| static SourceRange getFullCursorExtent(CXCursor C, SourceManager &SrcMgr) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|     if (!D)
 | |
|       return SourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceRange R = D->getSourceRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Adjust the start of the location for declarations preceded by
 | |
|     // declaration specifiers.
 | |
|     SourceLocation StartLoc;
 | |
|     if (const DeclaratorDecl *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = DD->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|         StartLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
 | |
|     } else if (const TypedefDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = Typedef->getTypeSourceInfo())
 | |
|         StartLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (StartLoc.isValid() && R.getBegin().isValid() &&
 | |
|         SrcMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(StartLoc, R.getBegin()))
 | |
|       R.setBegin(StartLoc);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration
 | |
|     // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their
 | |
|     // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context
 | |
|     // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup,
 | |
|     // and if so, whether it is the first decl.
 | |
|     if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C))
 | |
|         R.setBegin(VD->getLocation());
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return R;    
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return getRawCursorExtent(C);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRange clang_getCursorExtent(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   SourceRange R = getRawCursorExtent(C);
 | |
|   if (R.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceRange(getCursorContext(C), R);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCursorReferenced(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit tu = getCursorTU(C);
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|     if (!D)
 | |
|       return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|     if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D))
 | |
|       return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Using, D->getLocation(), tu);
 | |
|     if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImpl =
 | |
|             dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = PropImpl->getPropertyDecl())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(Property, tu);
 | |
|     
 | |
|     return C;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(C);
 | |
|     const Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E);
 | |
|     if (D) {
 | |
|       CXCursor declCursor = MakeCXCursor(D, tu);
 | |
|       declCursor = getSelectorIdentifierCursor(getSelectorIdentifierIndex(C),
 | |
|                                                declCursor);
 | |
|       return declCursor;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (const OverloadExpr *Ovl = dyn_cast_or_null<OverloadExpr>(E))
 | |
|       return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Ovl, tu);
 | |
|         
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C);
 | |
|     if (const GotoStmt *Goto = dyn_cast_or_null<GotoStmt>(S))
 | |
|       if (LabelDecl *label = Goto->getLabel())
 | |
|         if (LabelStmt *labelS = label->getStmt())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(labelS, getCursorDecl(C), tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) {
 | |
|     if (const MacroDefinitionRecord *Def =
 | |
|             getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeMacroDefinitionCursor(Def, tu);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!clang_isReference(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (C.kind) {
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).first, tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: {
 | |
|       const ObjCProtocolDecl *Prot = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).first;
 | |
|       if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *Def = Prot->getDefinition())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(Def, tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Prot, tu);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: {
 | |
|       const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = getCursorObjCClassRef(C).first;
 | |
|       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Class->getDefinition())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(Def, tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Class, tu);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TypeRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorTypeRef(C).first, tu );
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_TemplateRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorTemplateRef(C).first, tu );
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_NamespaceRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorNamespaceRef(C).first, tu );
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_MemberRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorMemberRef(C).first, tu );
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: {
 | |
|       const CXXBaseSpecifier *B = cxcursor::getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C);
 | |
|       return clang_getTypeDeclaration(cxtype::MakeCXType(B->getType(),
 | |
|                                                          tu ));
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_LabelRef:
 | |
|       // FIXME: We end up faking the "parent" declaration here because we
 | |
|       // don't want to make CXCursor larger.
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorLabelRef(C).first,
 | |
|                           cxtu::getASTUnit(tu)->getASTContext()
 | |
|                               .getTranslationUnitDecl(),
 | |
|                           tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef:
 | |
|       return C;
 | |
|       
 | |
|     case CXCursor_VariableRef:
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(getCursorVariableRef(C).first, tu);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       // We would prefer to enumerate all non-reference cursor kinds here.
 | |
|       llvm_unreachable("Unhandled reference cursor kind");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCursorDefinition(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool WasReference = false;
 | |
|   if (clang_isReference(C.kind) || clang_isExpression(C.kind)) {
 | |
|     C = clang_getCursorReferenced(C);
 | |
|     WasReference = true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion)
 | |
|     return clang_getCursorReferenced(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (D->getKind()) {
 | |
|   // Declaration kinds that don't really separate the notions of
 | |
|   // declaration and definition.
 | |
|   case Decl::Namespace:
 | |
|   case Decl::Typedef:
 | |
|   case Decl::TypeAlias:
 | |
|   case Decl::TypeAliasTemplate:
 | |
|   case Decl::TemplateTypeParm:
 | |
|   case Decl::EnumConstant:
 | |
|   case Decl::Field:
 | |
|   case Decl::Binding:
 | |
|   case Decl::MSProperty:
 | |
|   case Decl::IndirectField:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCIvar:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
 | |
|   case Decl::ImplicitParam:
 | |
|   case Decl::ParmVar:
 | |
|   case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm:
 | |
|   case Decl::TemplateTemplateParm:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCImplementation:
 | |
|   case Decl::AccessSpec:
 | |
|   case Decl::LinkageSpec:
 | |
|   case Decl::Export:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCPropertyImpl:
 | |
|   case Decl::FileScopeAsm:
 | |
|   case Decl::StaticAssert:
 | |
|   case Decl::Block:
 | |
|   case Decl::Captured:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr:
 | |
|   case Decl::Label:  // FIXME: Is this right??
 | |
|   case Decl::ClassScopeFunctionSpecialization:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide:
 | |
|   case Decl::Import:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPThreadPrivate:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPAllocate:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPDeclareMapper:
 | |
|   case Decl::OMPRequires:
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCTypeParam:
 | |
|   case Decl::BuiltinTemplate:
 | |
|   case Decl::PragmaComment:
 | |
|   case Decl::PragmaDetectMismatch:
 | |
|   case Decl::UsingPack:
 | |
|   case Decl::Concept:
 | |
|   case Decl::LifetimeExtendedTemporary:
 | |
|   case Decl::RequiresExprBody:
 | |
|     return C;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Declaration kinds that don't make any sense here, but are
 | |
|   // nonetheless harmless.
 | |
|   case Decl::Empty:
 | |
|   case Decl::TranslationUnit:
 | |
|   case Decl::ExternCContext:
 | |
|     break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Declaration kinds for which the definition is not resolvable.
 | |
|   case Decl::UnresolvedUsingTypename:
 | |
|   case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
 | |
|     break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::UsingDirective:
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingDirectiveDecl>(D)->getNominatedNamespace(),
 | |
|                         TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::NamespaceAlias:
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(cast<NamespaceAliasDecl>(D)->getNamespace(), TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::Enum:
 | |
|   case Decl::Record:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXRecord:
 | |
|   case Decl::ClassTemplateSpecialization:
 | |
|   case Decl::ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization:
 | |
|     if (TagDecl *Def = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::Function:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXMethod:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXConstructor:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXDestructor:
 | |
|   case Decl::CXXConversion: {
 | |
|     const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
 | |
|     if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->getBody(Def))
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::Var:
 | |
|   case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
 | |
|   case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
 | |
|   case Decl::Decomposition: {
 | |
|     // Ask the variable if it has a definition.
 | |
|     if (const VarDecl *Def = cast<VarDecl>(D)->getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::FunctionTemplate: {
 | |
|     const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
 | |
|     if (cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl()->getBody(Def))
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Def->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(), TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ClassTemplate: {
 | |
|     if (RecordDecl *Def = cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl()
 | |
|                                                             ->getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)->getDescribedClassTemplate(),
 | |
|                           TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::VarTemplate: {
 | |
|     if (VarDecl *Def =
 | |
|             cast<VarTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl()->getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(cast<VarDecl>(Def)->getDescribedVarTemplate(), TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::Using:
 | |
|     return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(cast<UsingDecl>(D), 
 | |
|                                        D->getLocation(), TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::UsingShadow:
 | |
|   case Decl::ConstructorUsingShadow:
 | |
|     return clang_getCursorDefinition(
 | |
|                        MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(),
 | |
|                                     TU));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCMethod: {
 | |
|     const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
 | |
|     if (Method->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|       return C;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Dig out the method definition in the associated
 | |
|     // @implementation, if we have it.
 | |
|     // FIXME: The ASTs should make finding the definition easier.
 | |
|     if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class
 | |
|                        = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()))
 | |
|       if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpl = Class->getImplementation())
 | |
|         if (ObjCMethodDecl *Def = ClassImpl->getMethod(Method->getSelector(),
 | |
|                                                   Method->isInstanceMethod()))
 | |
|           if (Def->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
 | |
|             return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCCategory:
 | |
|     if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl *Impl
 | |
|                                = cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)->getImplementation())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Impl, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCProtocol:
 | |
|     if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *Def = cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(D)->getDefinition())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCInterface: {
 | |
|     // There are two notions of a "definition" for an Objective-C
 | |
|     // class: the interface and its implementation. When we resolved a
 | |
|     // reference to an Objective-C class, produce the @interface as
 | |
|     // the definition; when we were provided with the interface,
 | |
|     // produce the @implementation as the definition.
 | |
|     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D);
 | |
|     if (WasReference) {
 | |
|       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = IFace->getDefinition())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
|     } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *Impl = IFace->getImplementation())
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(Impl, TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCProperty:
 | |
|     // FIXME: We don't really know where to find the
 | |
|     // ObjCPropertyImplDecls that implement this property.
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::ObjCCompatibleAlias:
 | |
|     if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class
 | |
|           = cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(D)->getClassInterface())
 | |
|       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Class->getDefinition())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::Friend:
 | |
|     if (NamedDecl *Friend = cast<FriendDecl>(D)->getFriendDecl())
 | |
|       return clang_getCursorDefinition(MakeCXCursor(Friend, TU));
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case Decl::FriendTemplate:
 | |
|     if (NamedDecl *Friend = cast<FriendTemplateDecl>(D)->getFriendDecl())
 | |
|       return clang_getCursorDefinition(MakeCXCursor(Friend, TU));
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_isCursorDefinition(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return clang_getCursorDefinition(C) == C;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCanonicalCursor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return C;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C)) {
 | |
|     if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CatImplD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD = CatImplD->getCategoryDecl())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(CatD, getCursorTU(C));
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (const ObjCImplDecl *ImplD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(D))
 | |
|       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFD = ImplD->getClassInterface())
 | |
|         return MakeCXCursor(IFD, getCursorTU(C));
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(D->getCanonicalDecl(), getCursorTU(C));
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return C;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_Cursor_getObjCSelectorIndex(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   return cxcursor::getSelectorIdentifierIndexAndLoc(cursor).first;
 | |
| }
 | |
|   
 | |
| unsigned clang_getNumOverloadedDecls(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind != CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).first;
 | |
|   if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>())
 | |
|     return E->getNumDecls();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *S
 | |
|                               = Storage.dyn_cast<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>())
 | |
|     return S->size();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const Decl *D = Storage.get<const Decl *>();
 | |
|   if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return Using->shadow_size();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getOverloadedDecl(CXCursor cursor, unsigned index) {
 | |
|   if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (index >= clang_getNumOverloadedDecls(cursor))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(cursor);
 | |
|   OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(cursor).first;
 | |
|   if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>())
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(E->decls_begin()[index], TU);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *S
 | |
|                               = Storage.dyn_cast<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>())
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(S->begin()[index], TU);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const Decl *D = Storage.get<const Decl *>();
 | |
|   if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     // FIXME: This is, unfortunately, linear time.
 | |
|     UsingDecl::shadow_iterator Pos = Using->shadow_begin();
 | |
|     std::advance(Pos, index);
 | |
|     return MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Pos)->getTargetDecl(), TU);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| }
 | |
|   
 | |
| void clang_getDefinitionSpellingAndExtent(CXCursor C,
 | |
|                                           const char **startBuf,
 | |
|                                           const char **endBuf,
 | |
|                                           unsigned *startLine,
 | |
|                                           unsigned *startColumn,
 | |
|                                           unsigned *endLine,
 | |
|                                           unsigned *endColumn) {
 | |
|   assert(getCursorDecl(C) && "CXCursor has null decl");
 | |
|   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(getCursorDecl(C));
 | |
|   CompoundStmt *Body = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(FD->getBody());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = FD->getASTContext().getSourceManager();
 | |
|   *startBuf = SM.getCharacterData(Body->getLBracLoc());
 | |
|   *endBuf = SM.getCharacterData(Body->getRBracLoc());
 | |
|   *startLine = SM.getSpellingLineNumber(Body->getLBracLoc());
 | |
|   *startColumn = SM.getSpellingColumnNumber(Body->getLBracLoc());
 | |
|   *endLine = SM.getSpellingLineNumber(Body->getRBracLoc());
 | |
|   *endColumn = SM.getSpellingColumnNumber(Body->getRBracLoc());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRange clang_getCursorReferenceNameRange(CXCursor C, unsigned NameFlags,
 | |
|                                                 unsigned PieceIndex) {
 | |
|   RefNamePieces Pieces;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   switch (C.kind) {
 | |
|   case CXCursor_MemberRefExpr:
 | |
|     if (const MemberExpr *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(getCursorExpr(C)))
 | |
|       Pieces = buildPieces(NameFlags, true, E->getMemberNameInfo(),
 | |
|                            E->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange());
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   case CXCursor_DeclRefExpr:
 | |
|     if (const DeclRefExpr *E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) {
 | |
|       SourceRange TemplateArgLoc(E->getLAngleLoc(), E->getRAngleLoc());
 | |
|       Pieces =
 | |
|           buildPieces(NameFlags, false, E->getNameInfo(),
 | |
|                       E->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(), &TemplateArgLoc);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|     
 | |
|   case CXCursor_CallExpr:
 | |
|     if (const CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = 
 | |
|         dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) {
 | |
|       const Expr *Callee = OCE->getCallee();
 | |
|       if (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Callee))
 | |
|         Callee = ICE->getSubExpr();
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Callee))
 | |
|         Pieces = buildPieces(NameFlags, false, DRE->getNameInfo(),
 | |
|                              DRE->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange());
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|     
 | |
|   default:
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Pieces.empty()) {
 | |
|     if (PieceIndex == 0)
 | |
|       return clang_getCursorExtent(C);
 | |
|   } else if (PieceIndex < Pieces.size()) {
 | |
|       SourceRange R = Pieces[PieceIndex];
 | |
|       if (R.isValid())
 | |
|         return cxloc::translateSourceRange(getCursorContext(C), R);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_enableStackTraces(void) {
 | |
|   // FIXME: Provide an argv0 here so we can find llvm-symbolizer.
 | |
|   llvm::sys::PrintStackTraceOnErrorSignal(StringRef());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_executeOnThread(void (*fn)(void*), void *user_data,
 | |
|                            unsigned stack_size) {
 | |
|   llvm::llvm_execute_on_thread(fn, user_data,
 | |
|                                stack_size == 0
 | |
|                                    ? clang::DesiredStackSize
 | |
|                                    : llvm::Optional<unsigned>(stack_size));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Token-based Operations.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* CXToken layout:
 | |
|  *   int_data[0]: a CXTokenKind
 | |
|  *   int_data[1]: starting token location
 | |
|  *   int_data[2]: token length
 | |
|  *   int_data[3]: reserved
 | |
|  *   ptr_data: for identifiers and keywords, an IdentifierInfo*.
 | |
|  *   otherwise unused.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| CXTokenKind clang_getTokenKind(CXToken CXTok) {
 | |
|   return static_cast<CXTokenKind>(CXTok.int_data[0]);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getTokenSpelling(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) {
 | |
|   switch (clang_getTokenKind(CXTok)) {
 | |
|   case CXToken_Identifier:
 | |
|   case CXToken_Keyword:
 | |
|     // We know we have an IdentifierInfo*, so use that.
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(CXTok.ptr_data)
 | |
|                             ->getNameStart());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case CXToken_Literal: {
 | |
|     // We have stashed the starting pointer in the ptr_data field. Use it.
 | |
|     const char *Text = static_cast<const char *>(CXTok.ptr_data);
 | |
|     return cxstring::createDup(StringRef(Text, CXTok.int_data[2]));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case CXToken_Punctuation:
 | |
|   case CXToken_Comment:
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // We have to find the starting buffer pointer the hard way, by
 | |
|   // deconstructing the source location.
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1]);
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo
 | |
|     = CXXUnit->getSourceManager().getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Loc);
 | |
|   bool Invalid = false;
 | |
|   StringRef Buffer
 | |
|     = CXXUnit->getSourceManager().getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid);
 | |
|   if (Invalid)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(Buffer.substr(LocInfo.second, CXTok.int_data[2]));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceLocation clang_getTokenLocation(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullLocation();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullLocation();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(CXXUnit->getASTContext(),
 | |
|                         SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1]));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRange clang_getTokenExtent(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceRange(CXXUnit->getASTContext(),
 | |
|                         SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1]));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void getTokens(ASTUnit *CXXUnit, SourceRange Range,
 | |
|                       SmallVectorImpl<CXToken> &CXTokens) {
 | |
|   SourceManager &SourceMgr = CXXUnit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> BeginLocInfo
 | |
|     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Range.getBegin());
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> EndLocInfo
 | |
|     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Range.getEnd());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Cannot tokenize across files.
 | |
|   if (BeginLocInfo.first != EndLocInfo.first)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Create a lexer
 | |
|   bool Invalid = false;
 | |
|   StringRef Buffer
 | |
|     = SourceMgr.getBufferData(BeginLocInfo.first, &Invalid);
 | |
|   if (Invalid)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   Lexer Lex(SourceMgr.getLocForStartOfFile(BeginLocInfo.first),
 | |
|             CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts(),
 | |
|             Buffer.begin(), Buffer.data() + BeginLocInfo.second, Buffer.end());
 | |
|   Lex.SetCommentRetentionState(true);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Lex tokens until we hit the end of the range.
 | |
|   const char *EffectiveBufferEnd = Buffer.data() + EndLocInfo.second;
 | |
|   Token Tok;
 | |
|   bool previousWasAt = false;
 | |
|   do {
 | |
|     // Lex the next token
 | |
|     Lex.LexFromRawLexer(Tok);
 | |
|     if (Tok.is(tok::eof))
 | |
|       break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Initialize the CXToken.
 | |
|     CXToken CXTok;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     //   - Common fields
 | |
|     CXTok.int_data[1] = Tok.getLocation().getRawEncoding();
 | |
|     CXTok.int_data[2] = Tok.getLength();
 | |
|     CXTok.int_data[3] = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     //   - Kind-specific fields
 | |
|     if (Tok.isLiteral()) {
 | |
|       CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Literal;
 | |
|       CXTok.ptr_data = const_cast<char *>(Tok.getLiteralData());
 | |
|     } else if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier)) {
 | |
|       // Lookup the identifier to determine whether we have a keyword.
 | |
|       IdentifierInfo *II
 | |
|         = CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().LookUpIdentifierInfo(Tok);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if ((II->getObjCKeywordID() != tok::objc_not_keyword) && previousWasAt) {
 | |
|         CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       else {
 | |
|         CXTok.int_data[0] = Tok.is(tok::identifier)
 | |
|           ? CXToken_Identifier
 | |
|           : CXToken_Keyword;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       CXTok.ptr_data = II;
 | |
|     } else if (Tok.is(tok::comment)) {
 | |
|       CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Comment;
 | |
|       CXTok.ptr_data = nullptr;
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Punctuation;
 | |
|       CXTok.ptr_data = nullptr;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     CXTokens.push_back(CXTok);
 | |
|     previousWasAt = Tok.is(tok::at);
 | |
|   } while (Lex.getBufferLocation() < EffectiveBufferEnd);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXToken *clang_getToken(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceLocation Location) {
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << TU << ' ' << Location;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit)
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation Begin = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(Location);
 | |
|   if (Begin.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = CXXUnit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DecomposedEnd = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Begin);
 | |
|   DecomposedEnd.second += Lexer::MeasureTokenLength(Begin, SM, CXXUnit->getLangOpts());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation End = SM.getComposedLoc(DecomposedEnd.first, DecomposedEnd.second);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SmallVector<CXToken, 32> CXTokens;
 | |
|   getTokens(CXXUnit, SourceRange(Begin, End), CXTokens);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (CXTokens.empty())
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTokens.resize(1);
 | |
|   CXToken *Token = static_cast<CXToken *>(llvm::safe_malloc(sizeof(CXToken)));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   memmove(Token, CXTokens.data(), sizeof(CXToken));
 | |
|   return Token;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_tokenize(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceRange Range,
 | |
|                     CXToken **Tokens, unsigned *NumTokens) {
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << TU << ' ' << Range;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Tokens)
 | |
|     *Tokens = nullptr;
 | |
|   if (NumTokens)
 | |
|     *NumTokens = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit || !Tokens || !NumTokens)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   SourceRange R = cxloc::translateCXSourceRange(Range);
 | |
|   if (R.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SmallVector<CXToken, 32> CXTokens;
 | |
|   getTokens(CXXUnit, R, CXTokens);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (CXTokens.empty())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *Tokens = static_cast<CXToken *>(
 | |
|       llvm::safe_malloc(sizeof(CXToken) * CXTokens.size()));
 | |
|   memmove(*Tokens, CXTokens.data(), sizeof(CXToken) * CXTokens.size());
 | |
|   *NumTokens = CXTokens.size();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                          CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens) {
 | |
|   free(Tokens);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Token annotation APIs.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| static enum CXChildVisitResult AnnotateTokensVisitor(CXCursor cursor,
 | |
|                                                      CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                                                      CXClientData client_data);
 | |
| static bool AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor(CXCursor cursor,
 | |
|                                               CXClientData client_data);
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| class AnnotateTokensWorker {
 | |
|   CXToken *Tokens;
 | |
|   CXCursor *Cursors;
 | |
|   unsigned NumTokens;
 | |
|   unsigned TokIdx;
 | |
|   unsigned PreprocessingTokIdx;
 | |
|   CursorVisitor AnnotateVis;
 | |
|   SourceManager &SrcMgr;
 | |
|   bool HasContextSensitiveKeywords;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   struct PostChildrenAction {
 | |
|     CXCursor cursor;
 | |
|     enum Action { Invalid, Ignore, Postpone } action;
 | |
|   };
 | |
|   using PostChildrenActions = SmallVector<PostChildrenAction, 0>;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   struct PostChildrenInfo {
 | |
|     CXCursor Cursor;
 | |
|     SourceRange CursorRange;
 | |
|     unsigned BeforeReachingCursorIdx;
 | |
|     unsigned BeforeChildrenTokenIdx;
 | |
|     PostChildrenActions ChildActions;
 | |
|   };
 | |
|   SmallVector<PostChildrenInfo, 8> PostChildrenInfos;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) {
 | |
|     assert(Idx < NumTokens);
 | |
|     return Tokens[Idx];
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) const {
 | |
|     assert(Idx < NumTokens);
 | |
|     return Tokens[Idx];
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   bool MoreTokens() const { return TokIdx < NumTokens; }
 | |
|   unsigned NextToken() const { return TokIdx; }
 | |
|   void AdvanceToken() { ++TokIdx; }
 | |
|   SourceLocation GetTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) {
 | |
|     return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[1]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   bool isFunctionMacroToken(unsigned tokI) const {
 | |
|     return getTok(tokI).int_data[3] != 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   SourceLocation getFunctionMacroTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) const {
 | |
|     return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[3]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   void annotateAndAdvanceTokens(CXCursor, RangeComparisonResult, SourceRange);
 | |
|   bool annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens(CXCursor, RangeComparisonResult,
 | |
|                                              SourceRange);
 | |
| 
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   AnnotateTokensWorker(CXToken *tokens, CXCursor *cursors, unsigned numTokens,
 | |
|                        CXTranslationUnit TU, SourceRange RegionOfInterest)
 | |
|     : Tokens(tokens), Cursors(cursors),
 | |
|       NumTokens(numTokens), TokIdx(0), PreprocessingTokIdx(0),
 | |
|       AnnotateVis(TU,
 | |
|                   AnnotateTokensVisitor, this,
 | |
|                   /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true,
 | |
|                   /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false,
 | |
|                   RegionOfInterest,
 | |
|                   /*VisitDeclsOnly=*/false,
 | |
|                   AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor),
 | |
|       SrcMgr(cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getSourceManager()),
 | |
|       HasContextSensitiveKeywords(false) { }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   void VisitChildren(CXCursor C) { AnnotateVis.VisitChildren(C); }
 | |
|   enum CXChildVisitResult Visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent);
 | |
|   bool IsIgnoredChildCursor(CXCursor cursor) const;
 | |
|   PostChildrenActions DetermineChildActions(CXCursor Cursor) const;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool postVisitChildren(CXCursor cursor);
 | |
|   void HandlePostPonedChildCursors(const PostChildrenInfo &Info);
 | |
|   void HandlePostPonedChildCursor(CXCursor Cursor, unsigned StartTokenIndex);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   void AnnotateTokens();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   /// Determine whether the annotator saw any cursors that have 
 | |
|   /// context-sensitive keywords.
 | |
|   bool hasContextSensitiveKeywords() const {
 | |
|     return HasContextSensitiveKeywords;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ~AnnotateTokensWorker() {
 | |
|     assert(PostChildrenInfos.empty());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void AnnotateTokensWorker::AnnotateTokens() {
 | |
|   // Walk the AST within the region of interest, annotating tokens
 | |
|   // along the way.
 | |
|   AnnotateVis.visitFileRegion();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool AnnotateTokensWorker::IsIgnoredChildCursor(CXCursor cursor) const {
 | |
|   if (PostChildrenInfos.empty())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (const auto &ChildAction : PostChildrenInfos.back().ChildActions) {
 | |
|     if (ChildAction.cursor == cursor &&
 | |
|         ChildAction.action == PostChildrenAction::Ignore) {
 | |
|       return true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const CXXOperatorCallExpr *GetSubscriptOrCallOperator(CXCursor Cursor) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isExpression(Cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(Cursor);
 | |
|   if (const auto *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
 | |
|     const OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = OCE->getOperator();
 | |
|     if (Kind == OO_Call || Kind == OO_Subscript)
 | |
|       return OCE;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| AnnotateTokensWorker::PostChildrenActions
 | |
| AnnotateTokensWorker::DetermineChildActions(CXCursor Cursor) const {
 | |
|   PostChildrenActions actions;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // The DeclRefExpr of CXXOperatorCallExpr refering to the custom operator is
 | |
|   // visited before the arguments to the operator call. For the Call and
 | |
|   // Subscript operator the range of this DeclRefExpr includes the whole call
 | |
|   // expression, so that all tokens in that range would be mapped to the
 | |
|   // operator function, including the tokens of the arguments. To avoid that,
 | |
|   // ensure to visit this DeclRefExpr as last node.
 | |
|   if (const auto *OCE = GetSubscriptOrCallOperator(Cursor)) {
 | |
|     const Expr *Callee = OCE->getCallee();
 | |
|     if (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Callee)) {
 | |
|       const Expr *SubExpr = ICE->getSubExpr();
 | |
|       if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)) {
 | |
|         const Decl *parentDecl = getCursorDecl(Cursor);
 | |
|         CXTranslationUnit TU = clang_Cursor_getTranslationUnit(Cursor);
 | |
| 
 | |
|         // Visit the DeclRefExpr as last.
 | |
|         CXCursor cxChild = MakeCXCursor(DRE, parentDecl, TU);
 | |
|         actions.push_back({cxChild, PostChildrenAction::Postpone});
 | |
| 
 | |
|         // The parent of the DeclRefExpr, an ImplicitCastExpr, has an equally
 | |
|         // wide range as the DeclRefExpr. We can skip visiting this entirely.
 | |
|         cxChild = MakeCXCursor(ICE, parentDecl, TU);
 | |
|         actions.push_back({cxChild, PostChildrenAction::Ignore});
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return actions;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static inline void updateCursorAnnotation(CXCursor &Cursor,
 | |
|                                           const CXCursor &updateC) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isInvalid(updateC.kind) || !clang_isInvalid(Cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   Cursor = updateC;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// It annotates and advances tokens with a cursor until the comparison
 | |
| //// between the cursor location and the source range is the same as
 | |
| /// \arg compResult.
 | |
| ///
 | |
| /// Pass RangeBefore to annotate tokens with a cursor until a range is reached.
 | |
| /// Pass RangeOverlap to annotate tokens inside a range.
 | |
| void AnnotateTokensWorker::annotateAndAdvanceTokens(CXCursor updateC,
 | |
|                                                RangeComparisonResult compResult,
 | |
|                                                SourceRange range) {
 | |
|   while (MoreTokens()) {
 | |
|     const unsigned I = NextToken();
 | |
|     if (isFunctionMacroToken(I))
 | |
|       if (!annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens(updateC, compResult, range))
 | |
|         return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I);
 | |
|     if (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, range) == compResult) {
 | |
|       updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[I], updateC);
 | |
|       AdvanceToken();
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Special annotation handling for macro argument tokens.
 | |
| /// \returns true if it advanced beyond all macro tokens, false otherwise.
 | |
| bool AnnotateTokensWorker::annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens(
 | |
|                                                CXCursor updateC,
 | |
|                                                RangeComparisonResult compResult,
 | |
|                                                SourceRange range) {
 | |
|   assert(MoreTokens());
 | |
|   assert(isFunctionMacroToken(NextToken()) &&
 | |
|          "Should be called only for macro arg tokens");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // This works differently than annotateAndAdvanceTokens; because expanded
 | |
|   // macro arguments can have arbitrary translation-unit source order, we do not
 | |
|   // advance the token index one by one until a token fails the range test.
 | |
|   // We only advance once past all of the macro arg tokens if all of them
 | |
|   // pass the range test. If one of them fails we keep the token index pointing
 | |
|   // at the start of the macro arg tokens so that the failing token will be
 | |
|   // annotated by a subsequent annotation try.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   bool atLeastOneCompFail = false;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   unsigned I = NextToken();
 | |
|   for (; I < NumTokens && isFunctionMacroToken(I); ++I) {
 | |
|     SourceLocation TokLoc = getFunctionMacroTokenLoc(I);
 | |
|     if (TokLoc.isFileID())
 | |
|       continue; // not macro arg token, it's parens or comma.
 | |
|     if (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, range) == compResult) {
 | |
|       if (clang_isInvalid(clang_getCursorKind(Cursors[I])))
 | |
|         Cursors[I] = updateC;
 | |
|     } else
 | |
|       atLeastOneCompFail = true;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (atLeastOneCompFail)
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   TokIdx = I; // All of the tokens were handled, advance beyond all of them.
 | |
|   return true;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CXChildVisitResult
 | |
| AnnotateTokensWorker::Visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent) {  
 | |
|   SourceRange cursorRange = getRawCursorExtent(cursor);
 | |
|   if (cursorRange.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (IsIgnoredChildCursor(cursor))
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!HasContextSensitiveKeywords) {
 | |
|     // Objective-C properties can have context-sensitive keywords.
 | |
|     if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) {
 | |
|       if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property
 | |
|                   = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor)))
 | |
|         HasContextSensitiveKeywords = Property->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten() != 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     // Objective-C methods can have context-sensitive keywords.
 | |
|     else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl ||
 | |
|              cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) {
 | |
|       if (const ObjCMethodDecl *Method
 | |
|             = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|         if (Method->getObjCDeclQualifier())
 | |
|           HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true;
 | |
|         else {
 | |
|           for (const auto *P : Method->parameters()) {
 | |
|             if (P->getObjCDeclQualifier()) {
 | |
|               HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true;
 | |
|               break;
 | |
|             }
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         }
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }    
 | |
|     // C++ methods can have context-sensitive keywords.
 | |
|     else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_CXXMethod) {
 | |
|       if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method
 | |
|                   = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) {
 | |
|         if (Method->hasAttr<FinalAttr>() || Method->hasAttr<OverrideAttr>())
 | |
|           HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     // C++ classes can have context-sensitive keywords.
 | |
|     else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_StructDecl ||
 | |
|              cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassDecl ||
 | |
|              cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassTemplate ||
 | |
|              cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization) {
 | |
|       if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor))
 | |
|         if (D->hasAttr<FinalAttr>())
 | |
|           HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Don't override a property annotation with its getter/setter method.
 | |
|   if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl &&
 | |
|       parent.kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl)
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Continue;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (clang_isPreprocessing(cursor.kind)) {    
 | |
|     // Items in the preprocessing record are kept separate from items in
 | |
|     // declarations, so we keep a separate token index.
 | |
|     unsigned SavedTokIdx = TokIdx;
 | |
|     TokIdx = PreprocessingTokIdx;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Skip tokens up until we catch up to the beginning of the preprocessing
 | |
|     // entry.
 | |
|     while (MoreTokens()) {
 | |
|       const unsigned I = NextToken();
 | |
|       SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I);
 | |
|       switch (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, cursorRange)) {
 | |
|       case RangeBefore:
 | |
|         AdvanceToken();
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       case RangeAfter:
 | |
|       case RangeOverlap:
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     // Look at all of the tokens within this range.
 | |
|     while (MoreTokens()) {
 | |
|       const unsigned I = NextToken();
 | |
|       SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I);
 | |
|       switch (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, cursorRange)) {
 | |
|       case RangeBefore:
 | |
|         llvm_unreachable("Infeasible");
 | |
|       case RangeAfter:
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|       case RangeOverlap:
 | |
|         // For macro expansions, just note where the beginning of the macro
 | |
|         // expansion occurs.
 | |
|         if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) {
 | |
|           if (TokLoc == cursorRange.getBegin())
 | |
|             Cursors[I] = cursor;
 | |
|           AdvanceToken();
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         // We may have already annotated macro names inside macro definitions.
 | |
|         if (Cursors[I].kind != CXCursor_MacroExpansion)
 | |
|           Cursors[I] = cursor;
 | |
|         AdvanceToken();
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Save the preprocessing token index; restore the non-preprocessing
 | |
|     // token index.
 | |
|     PreprocessingTokIdx = TokIdx;
 | |
|     TokIdx = SavedTokIdx;
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (cursorRange.isInvalid())
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   unsigned BeforeReachingCursorIdx = NextToken();
 | |
|   const enum CXCursorKind cursorK = clang_getCursorKind(cursor);
 | |
|   const enum CXCursorKind K = clang_getCursorKind(parent);
 | |
|   const CXCursor updateC =
 | |
|     (clang_isInvalid(K) || K == CXCursor_TranslationUnit ||
 | |
|      // Attributes are annotated out-of-order, skip tokens until we reach it.
 | |
|      clang_isAttribute(cursor.kind))
 | |
|      ? clang_getNullCursor() : parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   annotateAndAdvanceTokens(updateC, RangeBefore, cursorRange);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Avoid having the cursor of an expression "overwrite" the annotation of the
 | |
|   // variable declaration that it belongs to.
 | |
|   // This can happen for C++ constructor expressions whose range generally
 | |
|   // include the variable declaration, e.g.:
 | |
|   //  MyCXXClass foo; // Make sure we don't annotate 'foo' as a CallExpr cursor.
 | |
|   if (clang_isExpression(cursorK) && MoreTokens()) {
 | |
|     const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(cursor);
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) {
 | |
|       const unsigned I = NextToken();
 | |
|       if (E->getBeginLoc().isValid() && D->getLocation().isValid() &&
 | |
|           E->getBeginLoc() == D->getLocation() &&
 | |
|           E->getBeginLoc() == GetTokenLoc(I)) {
 | |
|         updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[I], updateC);
 | |
|         AdvanceToken();
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Before recursing into the children keep some state that we are going
 | |
|   // to use in the AnnotateTokensWorker::postVisitChildren callback to do some
 | |
|   // extra work after the child nodes are visited.
 | |
|   // Note that we don't call VisitChildren here to avoid traversing statements
 | |
|   // code-recursively which can blow the stack.
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PostChildrenInfo Info;
 | |
|   Info.Cursor = cursor;
 | |
|   Info.CursorRange = cursorRange;
 | |
|   Info.BeforeReachingCursorIdx = BeforeReachingCursorIdx;
 | |
|   Info.BeforeChildrenTokenIdx = NextToken();
 | |
|   Info.ChildActions = DetermineChildActions(cursor);
 | |
|   PostChildrenInfos.push_back(Info);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXChildVisit_Recurse;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool AnnotateTokensWorker::postVisitChildren(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (PostChildrenInfos.empty())
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
|   const PostChildrenInfo &Info = PostChildrenInfos.back();
 | |
|   if (!clang_equalCursors(Info.Cursor, cursor))
 | |
|     return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   HandlePostPonedChildCursors(Info);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const unsigned BeforeChildren = Info.BeforeChildrenTokenIdx;
 | |
|   const unsigned AfterChildren = NextToken();
 | |
|   SourceRange cursorRange = Info.CursorRange;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Scan the tokens that are at the end of the cursor, but are not captured
 | |
|   // but the child cursors.
 | |
|   annotateAndAdvanceTokens(cursor, RangeOverlap, cursorRange);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Scan the tokens that are at the beginning of the cursor, but are not
 | |
|   // capture by the child cursors.
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = BeforeChildren; I != AfterChildren; ++I) {
 | |
|     if (!clang_isInvalid(clang_getCursorKind(Cursors[I])))
 | |
|       break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     Cursors[I] = cursor;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Attributes are annotated out-of-order, rewind TokIdx to when we first
 | |
|   // encountered the attribute cursor.
 | |
|   if (clang_isAttribute(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     TokIdx = Info.BeforeReachingCursorIdx;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   PostChildrenInfos.pop_back();
 | |
|   return false;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void AnnotateTokensWorker::HandlePostPonedChildCursors(
 | |
|     const PostChildrenInfo &Info) {
 | |
|   for (const auto &ChildAction : Info.ChildActions) {
 | |
|     if (ChildAction.action == PostChildrenAction::Postpone) {
 | |
|       HandlePostPonedChildCursor(ChildAction.cursor,
 | |
|                                  Info.BeforeChildrenTokenIdx);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void AnnotateTokensWorker::HandlePostPonedChildCursor(
 | |
|     CXCursor Cursor, unsigned StartTokenIndex) {
 | |
|   unsigned I = StartTokenIndex;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // The bracket tokens of a Call or Subscript operator are mapped to
 | |
|   // CallExpr/CXXOperatorCallExpr because we skipped visiting the corresponding
 | |
|   // DeclRefExpr. Remap these tokens to the DeclRefExpr cursors.
 | |
|   for (unsigned RefNameRangeNr = 0; I < NumTokens; RefNameRangeNr++) {
 | |
|     const CXSourceRange CXRefNameRange = clang_getCursorReferenceNameRange(
 | |
|         Cursor, CXNameRange_WantQualifier, RefNameRangeNr);
 | |
|     if (clang_Range_isNull(CXRefNameRange))
 | |
|       break; // All ranges handled.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceRange RefNameRange = cxloc::translateCXSourceRange(CXRefNameRange);
 | |
|     while (I < NumTokens) {
 | |
|       const SourceLocation TokenLocation = GetTokenLoc(I);
 | |
|       if (!TokenLocation.isValid())
 | |
|         break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       // Adapt the end range, because LocationCompare() reports
 | |
|       // RangeOverlap even for the not-inclusive end location.
 | |
|       const SourceLocation fixedEnd =
 | |
|           RefNameRange.getEnd().getLocWithOffset(-1);
 | |
|       RefNameRange = SourceRange(RefNameRange.getBegin(), fixedEnd);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       const RangeComparisonResult ComparisonResult =
 | |
|           LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokenLocation, RefNameRange);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (ComparisonResult == RangeOverlap) {
 | |
|         Cursors[I++] = Cursor;
 | |
|       } else if (ComparisonResult == RangeBefore) {
 | |
|         ++I; // Not relevant token, check next one.
 | |
|       } else if (ComparisonResult == RangeAfter) {
 | |
|         break; // All tokens updated for current range, check next.
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static enum CXChildVisitResult AnnotateTokensVisitor(CXCursor cursor,
 | |
|                                                      CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                                                      CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   return static_cast<AnnotateTokensWorker*>(client_data)->Visit(cursor, parent);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static bool AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor(CXCursor cursor,
 | |
|                                               CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   return static_cast<AnnotateTokensWorker*>(client_data)->
 | |
|                                                       postVisitChildren(cursor);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace {
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Uses the macro expansions in the preprocessing record to find
 | |
| /// and mark tokens that are macro arguments. This info is used by the
 | |
| /// AnnotateTokensWorker.
 | |
| class MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor {
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM;
 | |
|   CXToken *Tokens;
 | |
|   unsigned NumTokens;
 | |
|   unsigned CurIdx;
 | |
|   
 | |
| public:
 | |
|   MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor(SourceManager &SM,
 | |
|                             CXToken *tokens, unsigned numTokens)
 | |
|     : SM(SM), Tokens(tokens), NumTokens(numTokens), CurIdx(0) { }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXChildVisitResult visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent) {
 | |
|     if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_MacroExpansion)
 | |
|       return CXChildVisit_Continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     SourceRange macroRange = getCursorMacroExpansion(cursor).getSourceRange();
 | |
|     if (macroRange.getBegin() == macroRange.getEnd())
 | |
|       return CXChildVisit_Continue; // it's not a function macro.
 | |
| 
 | |
|     for (; CurIdx < NumTokens; ++CurIdx) {
 | |
|       if (!SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(getTokenLoc(CurIdx),
 | |
|                                         macroRange.getBegin()))
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|     
 | |
|     if (CurIdx == NumTokens)
 | |
|       return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     for (; CurIdx < NumTokens; ++CurIdx) {
 | |
|       SourceLocation tokLoc = getTokenLoc(CurIdx);
 | |
|       if (!SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(tokLoc, macroRange.getEnd()))
 | |
|         break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       setFunctionMacroTokenLoc(CurIdx, SM.getMacroArgExpandedLocation(tokLoc));
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (CurIdx == NumTokens)
 | |
|       return CXChildVisit_Break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     return CXChildVisit_Continue;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
| private:
 | |
|   CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) {
 | |
|     assert(Idx < NumTokens);
 | |
|     return Tokens[Idx];
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   const CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) const {
 | |
|     assert(Idx < NumTokens);
 | |
|     return Tokens[Idx];
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SourceLocation getTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) {
 | |
|     return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[1]);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   void setFunctionMacroTokenLoc(unsigned tokI, SourceLocation loc) {
 | |
|     // The third field is reserved and currently not used. Use it here
 | |
|     // to mark macro arg expanded tokens with their expanded locations.
 | |
|     getTok(tokI).int_data[3] = loc.getRawEncoding();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| } // end anonymous namespace
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXChildVisitResult
 | |
| MarkMacroArgTokensVisitorDelegate(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent,
 | |
|                                   CXClientData client_data) {
 | |
|   return static_cast<MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor*>(client_data)->visit(cursor,
 | |
|                                                                      parent);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Used by \c annotatePreprocessorTokens.
 | |
| /// \returns true if lexing was finished, false otherwise.
 | |
| static bool lexNext(Lexer &Lex, Token &Tok,
 | |
|                    unsigned &NextIdx, unsigned NumTokens) {
 | |
|   if (NextIdx >= NumTokens)
 | |
|     return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ++NextIdx;
 | |
|   Lex.LexFromRawLexer(Tok);
 | |
|   return Tok.is(tok::eof);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void annotatePreprocessorTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                        SourceRange RegionOfInterest,
 | |
|                                        CXCursor *Cursors,
 | |
|                                        CXToken *Tokens,
 | |
|                                        unsigned NumTokens) {
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = CXXUnit->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   SourceManager &SourceMgr = CXXUnit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> BeginLocInfo
 | |
|     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(RegionOfInterest.getBegin());
 | |
|   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> EndLocInfo
 | |
|     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(RegionOfInterest.getEnd());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (BeginLocInfo.first != EndLocInfo.first)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   StringRef Buffer;
 | |
|   bool Invalid = false;
 | |
|   Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(BeginLocInfo.first, &Invalid);
 | |
|   if (Buffer.empty() || Invalid)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Lexer Lex(SourceMgr.getLocForStartOfFile(BeginLocInfo.first),
 | |
|             CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts(),
 | |
|             Buffer.begin(), Buffer.data() + BeginLocInfo.second,
 | |
|             Buffer.end());
 | |
|   Lex.SetCommentRetentionState(true);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   unsigned NextIdx = 0;
 | |
|   // Lex tokens in raw mode until we hit the end of the range, to avoid
 | |
|   // entering #includes or expanding macros.
 | |
|   while (true) {
 | |
|     Token Tok;
 | |
|     if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens))
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     unsigned TokIdx = NextIdx-1;
 | |
|     assert(Tok.getLocation() ==
 | |
|              SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(Tokens[TokIdx].int_data[1]));
 | |
|     
 | |
|   reprocess:
 | |
|     if (Tok.is(tok::hash) && Tok.isAtStartOfLine()) {
 | |
|       // We have found a preprocessing directive. Annotate the tokens
 | |
|       // appropriately.
 | |
|       //
 | |
|       // FIXME: Some simple tests here could identify macro definitions and
 | |
|       // #undefs, to provide specific cursor kinds for those.
 | |
| 
 | |
|       SourceLocation BeginLoc = Tok.getLocation();
 | |
|       if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens))
 | |
|         break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       MacroInfo *MI = nullptr;
 | |
|       if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier) && Tok.getRawIdentifier() == "define") {
 | |
|         if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens))
 | |
|           break;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier)) {
 | |
|           IdentifierInfo &II =
 | |
|               PP.getIdentifierTable().get(Tok.getRawIdentifier());
 | |
|           SourceLocation MappedTokLoc =
 | |
|               CXXUnit->mapLocationToPreamble(Tok.getLocation());
 | |
|           MI = getMacroInfo(II, MappedTokLoc, TU);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       bool finished = false;
 | |
|       do {
 | |
|         if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens)) {
 | |
|           finished = true;
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         // If we are in a macro definition, check if the token was ever a
 | |
|         // macro name and annotate it if that's the case.
 | |
|         if (MI) {
 | |
|           SourceLocation SaveLoc = Tok.getLocation();
 | |
|           Tok.setLocation(CXXUnit->mapLocationToPreamble(SaveLoc));
 | |
|           MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef =
 | |
|               checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Tok, TU);
 | |
|           Tok.setLocation(SaveLoc);
 | |
|           if (MacroDef)
 | |
|             Cursors[NextIdx - 1] =
 | |
|                 MakeMacroExpansionCursor(MacroDef, Tok.getLocation(), TU);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|       } while (!Tok.isAtStartOfLine());
 | |
| 
 | |
|       unsigned LastIdx = finished ? NextIdx-1 : NextIdx-2;
 | |
|       assert(TokIdx <= LastIdx);
 | |
|       SourceLocation EndLoc =
 | |
|           SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(Tokens[LastIdx].int_data[1]);
 | |
|       CXCursor Cursor =
 | |
|           MakePreprocessingDirectiveCursor(SourceRange(BeginLoc, EndLoc), TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (; TokIdx <= LastIdx; ++TokIdx)
 | |
|         updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[TokIdx], Cursor);
 | |
|       
 | |
|       if (finished)
 | |
|         break;
 | |
|       goto reprocess;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| // This gets run a separate thread to avoid stack blowout.
 | |
| static void clang_annotateTokensImpl(CXTranslationUnit TU, ASTUnit *CXXUnit,
 | |
|                                      CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens,
 | |
|                                      CXCursor *Cursors) {
 | |
|   CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx;
 | |
|   if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing))
 | |
|     setThreadBackgroundPriority();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Determine the region of interest, which contains all of the tokens.
 | |
|   SourceRange RegionOfInterest;
 | |
|   RegionOfInterest.setBegin(
 | |
|     cxloc::translateSourceLocation(clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[0])));
 | |
|   RegionOfInterest.setEnd(
 | |
|     cxloc::translateSourceLocation(clang_getTokenLocation(TU,
 | |
|                                                          Tokens[NumTokens-1])));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Relex the tokens within the source range to look for preprocessing
 | |
|   // directives.
 | |
|   annotatePreprocessorTokens(TU, RegionOfInterest, Cursors, Tokens, NumTokens);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If begin location points inside a macro argument, set it to the expansion
 | |
|   // location so we can have the full context when annotating semantically.
 | |
|   {
 | |
|     SourceManager &SM = CXXUnit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|     SourceLocation Loc =
 | |
|         SM.getMacroArgExpandedLocation(RegionOfInterest.getBegin());
 | |
|     if (Loc.isMacroID())
 | |
|       RegionOfInterest.setBegin(SM.getExpansionLoc(Loc));
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord()) {
 | |
|     // Search and mark tokens that are macro argument expansions.
 | |
|     MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor Visitor(CXXUnit->getSourceManager(),
 | |
|                                       Tokens, NumTokens);
 | |
|     CursorVisitor MacroArgMarker(TU,
 | |
|                                  MarkMacroArgTokensVisitorDelegate, &Visitor,
 | |
|                                  /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true,
 | |
|                                  /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false,
 | |
|                                  RegionOfInterest);
 | |
|     MacroArgMarker.visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // Annotate all of the source locations in the region of interest that map to
 | |
|   // a specific cursor.
 | |
|   AnnotateTokensWorker W(Tokens, Cursors, NumTokens, TU, RegionOfInterest);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // FIXME: We use a ridiculous stack size here because the data-recursion
 | |
|   // algorithm uses a large stack frame than the non-data recursive version,
 | |
|   // and AnnotationTokensWorker currently transforms the data-recursion
 | |
|   // algorithm back into a traditional recursion by explicitly calling
 | |
|   // VisitChildren().  We will need to remove this explicit recursive call.
 | |
|   W.AnnotateTokens();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // If we ran into any entities that involve context-sensitive keywords,
 | |
|   // take another pass through the tokens to mark them as such.
 | |
|   if (W.hasContextSensitiveKeywords()) {
 | |
|     for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTokens; ++I) {
 | |
|       if (clang_getTokenKind(Tokens[I]) != CXToken_Identifier)
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       
 | |
|       if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) {
 | |
|         IdentifierInfo *II = static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(Tokens[I].ptr_data);
 | |
|         if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property
 | |
|             = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(Cursors[I]))) {
 | |
|           if (Property->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten() != 0 &&
 | |
|               llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(II->getName())
 | |
|               .Case("readonly", true)
 | |
|               .Case("assign", true)
 | |
|               .Case("unsafe_unretained", true)
 | |
|               .Case("readwrite", true)
 | |
|               .Case("retain", true)
 | |
|               .Case("copy", true)
 | |
|               .Case("nonatomic", true)
 | |
|               .Case("atomic", true)
 | |
|               .Case("getter", true)
 | |
|               .Case("setter", true)
 | |
|               .Case("strong", true)
 | |
|               .Case("weak", true)
 | |
|               .Case("class", true)
 | |
|               .Default(false))
 | |
|             Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       
 | |
|       if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl ||
 | |
|           Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) {
 | |
|         IdentifierInfo *II = static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(Tokens[I].ptr_data);
 | |
|         if (llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(II->getName())
 | |
|             .Case("in", true)
 | |
|             .Case("out", true)
 | |
|             .Case("inout", true)
 | |
|             .Case("oneway", true)
 | |
|             .Case("bycopy", true)
 | |
|             .Case("byref", true)
 | |
|             .Default(false))
 | |
|           Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_CXXFinalAttr ||
 | |
|           Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_CXXOverrideAttr) {
 | |
|         Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword;
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_annotateTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                           CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens,
 | |
|                           CXCursor *Cursors) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (NumTokens == 0 || !Tokens || !Cursors) {
 | |
|     LOG_FUNC_SECTION { *Log << "<null input>"; }
 | |
|     return;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   LOG_FUNC_SECTION {
 | |
|     *Log << TU << ' ';
 | |
|     CXSourceLocation bloc = clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[0]);
 | |
|     CXSourceLocation eloc = clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[NumTokens-1]);
 | |
|     *Log << clang_getRange(bloc, eloc);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Any token we don't specifically annotate will have a NULL cursor.
 | |
|   CXCursor C = clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTokens; ++I)
 | |
|     Cursors[I] = C;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   if (!CXXUnit)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   auto AnnotateTokensImpl = [=]() {
 | |
|     clang_annotateTokensImpl(TU, CXXUnit, Tokens, NumTokens, Cursors);
 | |
|   };
 | |
|   llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC;
 | |
|   if (!RunSafely(CRC, AnnotateTokensImpl, GetSafetyThreadStackSize() * 2)) {
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected while annotating tokens\n");
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Operations for querying linkage of a cursor.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXLinkageKind clang_getCursorLinkage(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return CXLinkage_Invalid;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor);
 | |
|   if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast_or_null<NamedDecl>(D))
 | |
|     switch (ND->getLinkageInternal()) {
 | |
|       case NoLinkage:
 | |
|       case VisibleNoLinkage: return CXLinkage_NoLinkage;
 | |
|       case ModuleInternalLinkage:
 | |
|       case InternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_Internal;
 | |
|       case UniqueExternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_UniqueExternal;
 | |
|       case ModuleLinkage:
 | |
|       case ExternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_External;
 | |
|     };
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXLinkage_Invalid;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Operations for querying visibility of a cursor.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXVisibilityKind clang_getCursorVisibility(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return CXVisibility_Invalid;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor);
 | |
|   if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast_or_null<NamedDecl>(D))
 | |
|     switch (ND->getVisibility()) {
 | |
|       case HiddenVisibility: return CXVisibility_Hidden;
 | |
|       case ProtectedVisibility: return CXVisibility_Protected;
 | |
|       case DefaultVisibility: return CXVisibility_Default;
 | |
|     };
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXVisibility_Invalid;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Operations for querying language of a cursor.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXLanguageKind getDeclLanguage(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return CXLanguage_C;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (D->getKind()) {
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case Decl::ImplicitParam:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCCategory:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCCompatibleAlias:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCImplementation:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCInterface:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCIvar:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCMethod:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCProperty:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCPropertyImpl:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCProtocol:
 | |
|     case Decl::ObjCTypeParam:
 | |
|       return CXLanguage_ObjC;
 | |
|     case Decl::CXXConstructor:
 | |
|     case Decl::CXXConversion:
 | |
|     case Decl::CXXDestructor:
 | |
|     case Decl::CXXMethod:
 | |
|     case Decl::CXXRecord:
 | |
|     case Decl::ClassTemplate:
 | |
|     case Decl::ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization:
 | |
|     case Decl::ClassTemplateSpecialization:
 | |
|     case Decl::Friend:
 | |
|     case Decl::FriendTemplate:
 | |
|     case Decl::FunctionTemplate:
 | |
|     case Decl::LinkageSpec:
 | |
|     case Decl::Namespace:
 | |
|     case Decl::NamespaceAlias:
 | |
|     case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm:
 | |
|     case Decl::StaticAssert:
 | |
|     case Decl::TemplateTemplateParm:
 | |
|     case Decl::TemplateTypeParm:
 | |
|     case Decl::UnresolvedUsingTypename:
 | |
|     case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
 | |
|     case Decl::Using:
 | |
|     case Decl::UsingDirective:
 | |
|     case Decl::UsingShadow:
 | |
|       return CXLanguage_CPlusPlus;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXLanguage_C;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXAvailabilityKind getCursorAvailabilityForDecl(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isDeleted())
 | |
|     return CXAvailability_NotAvailable;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   switch (D->getAvailability()) {
 | |
|   case AR_Available:
 | |
|   case AR_NotYetIntroduced:
 | |
|     if (const EnumConstantDecl *EnumConst = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D))
 | |
|       return getCursorAvailabilityForDecl(
 | |
|           cast<Decl>(EnumConst->getDeclContext()));
 | |
|     return CXAvailability_Available;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case AR_Deprecated:
 | |
|     return CXAvailability_Deprecated;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   case AR_Unavailable:
 | |
|     return CXAvailability_NotAvailable;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Unknown availability kind!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CXAvailabilityKind clang_getCursorAvailability(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor))
 | |
|       return getCursorAvailabilityForDecl(D);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXAvailability_Available;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static CXVersion convertVersion(VersionTuple In) {
 | |
|   CXVersion Out = { -1, -1, -1 };
 | |
|   if (In.empty())
 | |
|     return Out;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Out.Major = In.getMajor();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   Optional<unsigned> Minor = In.getMinor();
 | |
|   if (Minor.hasValue())
 | |
|     Out.Minor = *Minor;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return Out;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Optional<unsigned> Subminor = In.getSubminor();
 | |
|   if (Subminor.hasValue())
 | |
|     Out.Subminor = *Subminor;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return Out;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl(
 | |
|     const Decl *D, int *always_deprecated, CXString *deprecated_message,
 | |
|     int *always_unavailable, CXString *unavailable_message,
 | |
|     SmallVectorImpl<AvailabilityAttr *> &AvailabilityAttrs) {
 | |
|   bool HadAvailAttr = false;
 | |
|   for (auto A : D->attrs()) {
 | |
|     if (DeprecatedAttr *Deprecated = dyn_cast<DeprecatedAttr>(A)) {
 | |
|       HadAvailAttr = true;
 | |
|       if (always_deprecated)
 | |
|         *always_deprecated = 1;
 | |
|       if (deprecated_message) {
 | |
|         clang_disposeString(*deprecated_message);
 | |
|         *deprecated_message = cxstring::createDup(Deprecated->getMessage());
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (UnavailableAttr *Unavailable = dyn_cast<UnavailableAttr>(A)) {
 | |
|       HadAvailAttr = true;
 | |
|       if (always_unavailable)
 | |
|         *always_unavailable = 1;
 | |
|       if (unavailable_message) {
 | |
|         clang_disposeString(*unavailable_message);
 | |
|         *unavailable_message = cxstring::createDup(Unavailable->getMessage());
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       continue;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (AvailabilityAttr *Avail = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(A)) {
 | |
|       AvailabilityAttrs.push_back(Avail);
 | |
|       HadAvailAttr = true;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!HadAvailAttr)
 | |
|     if (const EnumConstantDecl *EnumConst = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D))
 | |
|       return getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl(
 | |
|           cast<Decl>(EnumConst->getDeclContext()), always_deprecated,
 | |
|           deprecated_message, always_unavailable, unavailable_message,
 | |
|           AvailabilityAttrs);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (AvailabilityAttrs.empty())
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm::sort(AvailabilityAttrs,
 | |
|              [](AvailabilityAttr *LHS, AvailabilityAttr *RHS) {
 | |
|                return LHS->getPlatform()->getName() <
 | |
|                       RHS->getPlatform()->getName();
 | |
|              });
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext();
 | |
|   auto It = std::unique(
 | |
|       AvailabilityAttrs.begin(), AvailabilityAttrs.end(),
 | |
|       [&Ctx](AvailabilityAttr *LHS, AvailabilityAttr *RHS) {
 | |
|         if (LHS->getPlatform() != RHS->getPlatform())
 | |
|           return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (LHS->getIntroduced() == RHS->getIntroduced() &&
 | |
|             LHS->getDeprecated() == RHS->getDeprecated() &&
 | |
|             LHS->getObsoleted() == RHS->getObsoleted() &&
 | |
|             LHS->getMessage() == RHS->getMessage() &&
 | |
|             LHS->getReplacement() == RHS->getReplacement())
 | |
|           return true;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if ((!LHS->getIntroduced().empty() && !RHS->getIntroduced().empty()) ||
 | |
|             (!LHS->getDeprecated().empty() && !RHS->getDeprecated().empty()) ||
 | |
|             (!LHS->getObsoleted().empty() && !RHS->getObsoleted().empty()))
 | |
|           return false;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (LHS->getIntroduced().empty() && !RHS->getIntroduced().empty())
 | |
|           LHS->setIntroduced(Ctx, RHS->getIntroduced());
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (LHS->getDeprecated().empty() && !RHS->getDeprecated().empty()) {
 | |
|           LHS->setDeprecated(Ctx, RHS->getDeprecated());
 | |
|           if (LHS->getMessage().empty())
 | |
|             LHS->setMessage(Ctx, RHS->getMessage());
 | |
|           if (LHS->getReplacement().empty())
 | |
|             LHS->setReplacement(Ctx, RHS->getReplacement());
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (LHS->getObsoleted().empty() && !RHS->getObsoleted().empty()) {
 | |
|           LHS->setObsoleted(Ctx, RHS->getObsoleted());
 | |
|           if (LHS->getMessage().empty())
 | |
|             LHS->setMessage(Ctx, RHS->getMessage());
 | |
|           if (LHS->getReplacement().empty())
 | |
|             LHS->setReplacement(Ctx, RHS->getReplacement());
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|         return true;
 | |
|       });
 | |
|   AvailabilityAttrs.erase(It, AvailabilityAttrs.end());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_getCursorPlatformAvailability(CXCursor cursor, int *always_deprecated,
 | |
|                                         CXString *deprecated_message,
 | |
|                                         int *always_unavailable,
 | |
|                                         CXString *unavailable_message,
 | |
|                                         CXPlatformAvailability *availability,
 | |
|                                         int availability_size) {
 | |
|   if (always_deprecated)
 | |
|     *always_deprecated = 0;
 | |
|   if (deprecated_message)
 | |
|     *deprecated_message = cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   if (always_unavailable)
 | |
|     *always_unavailable = 0;
 | |
|   if (unavailable_message)
 | |
|     *unavailable_message = cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor);
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   SmallVector<AvailabilityAttr *, 8> AvailabilityAttrs;
 | |
|   getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl(D, always_deprecated, deprecated_message,
 | |
|                                        always_unavailable, unavailable_message,
 | |
|                                        AvailabilityAttrs);
 | |
|   for (const auto &Avail :
 | |
|        llvm::enumerate(llvm::makeArrayRef(AvailabilityAttrs)
 | |
|                            .take_front(availability_size))) {
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Platform =
 | |
|         cxstring::createDup(Avail.value()->getPlatform()->getName());
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Introduced =
 | |
|         convertVersion(Avail.value()->getIntroduced());
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Deprecated =
 | |
|         convertVersion(Avail.value()->getDeprecated());
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Obsoleted =
 | |
|         convertVersion(Avail.value()->getObsoleted());
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Unavailable = Avail.value()->getUnavailable();
 | |
|     availability[Avail.index()].Message =
 | |
|         cxstring::createDup(Avail.value()->getMessage());
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return AvailabilityAttrs.size();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeCXPlatformAvailability(CXPlatformAvailability *availability) {
 | |
|   clang_disposeString(availability->Platform);
 | |
|   clang_disposeString(availability->Message);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXLanguageKind clang_getCursorLanguage(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind))
 | |
|     return getDeclLanguage(cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXLanguage_Invalid;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTLSKind clang_getCursorTLSKind(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor);
 | |
|   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|     switch (VD->getTLSKind()) {
 | |
|     case VarDecl::TLS_None:
 | |
|       return CXTLS_None;
 | |
|     case VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic:
 | |
|       return CXTLS_Dynamic;
 | |
|     case VarDecl::TLS_Static:
 | |
|       return CXTLS_Static;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return CXTLS_None;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
|  /// If the given cursor is the "templated" declaration
 | |
|  /// describing a class or function template, return the class or
 | |
|  /// function template.
 | |
| static const Decl *maybeGetTemplateCursor(const Decl *D) {
 | |
|   if (!D)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D))
 | |
|     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
 | |
|       return FunTmpl;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D))
 | |
|     if (ClassTemplateDecl *ClassTmpl = RD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
 | |
|       return ClassTmpl;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return D;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum CX_StorageClass clang_Cursor_getStorageClass(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   StorageClass sc = SC_None;
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (D) {
 | |
|     if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       sc = FD->getStorageClass();
 | |
|     } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
 | |
|       sc = VD->getStorageClass();
 | |
|     } else {
 | |
|       return CX_SC_Invalid;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   } else {
 | |
|     return CX_SC_Invalid;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   switch (sc) {
 | |
|   case SC_None:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_None;
 | |
|   case SC_Extern:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_Extern;
 | |
|   case SC_Static:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_Static;
 | |
|   case SC_PrivateExtern:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_PrivateExtern;
 | |
|   case SC_Auto:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_Auto;
 | |
|   case SC_Register:
 | |
|     return CX_SC_Register;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled storage class!");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCursorSemanticParent(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) {
 | |
|       const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext();
 | |
|       if (!DC)
 | |
|         return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(maybeGetTemplateCursor(cast<Decl>(DC)), 
 | |
|                           getCursorTU(cursor));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (clang_isStatement(cursor.kind) || clang_isExpression(cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor))
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(D, getCursorTU(cursor));
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXCursor clang_getCursorLexicalParent(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) {
 | |
|     if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) {
 | |
|       const DeclContext *DC = D->getLexicalDeclContext();
 | |
|       if (!DC)
 | |
|         return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return MakeCXCursor(maybeGetTemplateCursor(cast<Decl>(DC)), 
 | |
|                           getCursorTU(cursor));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // FIXME: Note that we can't easily compute the lexical context of a 
 | |
|   // statement or expression, so we return nothing.
 | |
|   return clang_getNullCursor();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXFile clang_getIncludedFile(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_InclusionDirective)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const InclusionDirective *ID = getCursorInclusionDirective(cursor);
 | |
|   return const_cast<FileEntry *>(ID->getFile());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_getObjCPropertyAttributes(CXCursor C, unsigned reserved) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind != CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl)
 | |
|     return CXObjCPropertyAttr_noattr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   unsigned Result = CXObjCPropertyAttr_noattr;
 | |
|   const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(C));
 | |
|   ObjCPropertyDecl::PropertyAttributeKind Attr =
 | |
|       PD->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten();
 | |
| 
 | |
| #define SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(A) \
 | |
|   if (Attr & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_##A) \
 | |
|     Result |= CXObjCPropertyAttr_##A
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(readonly);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(getter);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(assign);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(readwrite);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(retain);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(copy);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(nonatomic);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(setter);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(atomic);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(weak);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(strong);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(unsafe_unretained);
 | |
|   SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(class);
 | |
| #undef SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Cursor_getObjCPropertyGetterName(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind != CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(C));
 | |
|   Selector sel = PD->getGetterName();
 | |
|   if (sel.isNull())
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(sel.getAsString());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Cursor_getObjCPropertySetterName(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind != CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(C));
 | |
|   Selector sel = PD->getSetterName();
 | |
|   if (sel.isNull())
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(sel.getAsString());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_getObjCDeclQualifiers(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return CXObjCDeclQualifier_None;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT = Decl::OBJC_TQ_None;
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|     QT = MD->getObjCDeclQualifier();
 | |
|   else if (const ParmVarDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D))
 | |
|     QT = PD->getObjCDeclQualifier();
 | |
|   if (QT == Decl::OBJC_TQ_None)
 | |
|     return CXObjCDeclQualifier_None;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   unsigned Result = CXObjCDeclQualifier_None;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_In;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Inout;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Out;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Bycopy;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Byref;
 | |
|   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Oneway;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return Result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isObjCOptional(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return PD->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyDecl::Optional;
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return MD->getImplementationControl() == ObjCMethodDecl::Optional;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isVariadic(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return FD->isVariadic();
 | |
|   if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D))
 | |
|     return MD->isVariadic();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Cursor_isExternalSymbol(CXCursor C,
 | |
|                                      CXString *language, CXString *definedIn,
 | |
|                                      unsigned *isGenerated) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (auto *attr = D->getExternalSourceSymbolAttr()) {
 | |
|     if (language)
 | |
|       *language = cxstring::createDup(attr->getLanguage());
 | |
|     if (definedIn)
 | |
|       *definedIn = cxstring::createDup(attr->getDefinedIn());
 | |
|     if (isGenerated)
 | |
|       *isGenerated = attr->getGeneratedDeclaration();
 | |
|     return 1;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getCommentRange(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C);
 | |
|   const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D);
 | |
|   if (!RC)
 | |
|     return clang_getNullRange();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Context, RC->getSourceRange());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Cursor_getRawCommentText(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C);
 | |
|   const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D);
 | |
|   StringRef RawText = RC ? RC->getRawText(Context.getSourceManager()) :
 | |
|                            StringRef();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Don't duplicate the string because RawText points directly into source
 | |
|   // code.
 | |
|   return cxstring::createRef(RawText);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Cursor_getBriefCommentText(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C);
 | |
|   const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (RC) {
 | |
|     StringRef BriefText = RC->getBriefText(Context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     // Don't duplicate the string because RawComment ensures that this memory
 | |
|     // will not go away.
 | |
|     return cxstring::createRef(BriefText);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cxstring::createNull();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXModule clang_Cursor_getModule(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind == CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl) {
 | |
|     if (const ImportDecl *ImportD =
 | |
|             dyn_cast_or_null<ImportDecl>(getCursorDecl(C)))
 | |
|       return ImportD->getImportedModule();
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXModule clang_getModuleForFile(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile File) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (!File)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   FileEntry *FE = static_cast<FileEntry *>(File);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   ASTUnit &Unit = *cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   HeaderSearch &HS = Unit.getPreprocessor().getHeaderSearchInfo();
 | |
|   ModuleMap::KnownHeader Header = HS.findModuleForHeader(FE);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return Header.getModule();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXFile clang_Module_getASTFile(CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   return const_cast<FileEntry *>(Mod->getASTFile());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXModule clang_Module_getParent(CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   return Mod->Parent;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Module_getName(CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(Mod->Name);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_Module_getFullName(CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return cxstring::createEmpty();
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(Mod->getFullModuleName());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| int clang_Module_isSystem(CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   return Mod->IsSystem;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_Module_getNumTopLevelHeaders(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                             CXModule CXMod) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   FileManager &FileMgr = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getFileManager();
 | |
|   ArrayRef<const FileEntry *> TopHeaders = Mod->getTopHeaders(FileMgr);
 | |
|   return TopHeaders.size();
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXFile clang_Module_getTopLevelHeader(CXTranslationUnit TU,
 | |
|                                       CXModule CXMod, unsigned Index) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   if (!CXMod)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod);
 | |
|   FileManager &FileMgr = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getFileManager();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ArrayRef<const FileEntry *> TopHeaders = Mod->getTopHeaders(FileMgr);
 | |
|   if (Index < TopHeaders.size())
 | |
|     return const_cast<FileEntry *>(TopHeaders[Index]);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // C++ AST instrospection.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isDefaultConstructor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isCopyConstructor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Constructor && Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isMoveConstructor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Constructor && Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isConvertingConstructor(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   // Passing 'false' excludes constructors marked 'explicit'.
 | |
|   return (Constructor && Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(false)) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXField_isMutable(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (const auto D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C))
 | |
|     if (const auto FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D))
 | |
|       return FD->isMutable() ? 1 : 0;
 | |
|   return 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isPureVirtual(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXMethodDecl *Method =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Method && Method->isVirtual() && Method->isPure()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isConst(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXMethodDecl *Method =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Method && Method->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isDefaulted(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXMethodDecl *Method =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Method && Method->isDefaulted()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isStatic(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXMethodDecl *Method =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Method && Method->isStatic()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isVirtual(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const CXXMethodDecl *Method =
 | |
|       D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr;
 | |
|   return (Method && Method->isVirtual()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_CXXRecord_isAbstract(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const auto *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   const auto *RD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
 | |
|   if (RD)
 | |
|     RD = RD->getDefinition();
 | |
|   return (RD && RD->isAbstract()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned clang_EnumDecl_isScoped(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind))
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C);
 | |
|   auto *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(D);
 | |
|   return (Enum && Enum->isScoped()) ? 1 : 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Attribute introspection.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXType clang_getIBOutletCollectionType(CXCursor C) {
 | |
|   if (C.kind != CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr)
 | |
|     return cxtype::MakeCXType(QualType(), cxcursor::getCursorTU(C));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   const IBOutletCollectionAttr *A =
 | |
|     cast<IBOutletCollectionAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C));
 | |
|   
 | |
|   return cxtype::MakeCXType(A->getInterface(), cxcursor::getCursorTU(C));  
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Inspecting memory usage.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef std::vector<CXTUResourceUsageEntry> MemUsageEntries;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static inline void createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(MemUsageEntries &entries,
 | |
|                                               enum CXTUResourceUsageKind k,
 | |
|                                               unsigned long amount) {
 | |
|   CXTUResourceUsageEntry entry = { k, amount };
 | |
|   entries.push_back(entry);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const char *clang_getTUResourceUsageName(CXTUResourceUsageKind kind) {
 | |
|   const char *str = "";
 | |
|   switch (kind) {
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_AST:
 | |
|       str = "ASTContext: expressions, declarations, and types"; 
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_Identifiers:
 | |
|       str = "ASTContext: identifiers";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_Selectors:
 | |
|       str = "ASTContext: selectors";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_GlobalCompletionResults:
 | |
|       str = "Code completion: cached global results";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManagerContentCache:
 | |
|       str = "SourceManager: content cache allocator";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_AST_SideTables:
 | |
|       str = "ASTContext: side tables";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_Malloc:
 | |
|       str = "SourceManager: malloc'ed memory buffers";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_MMap:
 | |
|       str = "SourceManager: mmap'ed memory buffers";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_Malloc:
 | |
|       str = "ExternalASTSource: malloc'ed memory buffers";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_MMap:
 | |
|       str = "ExternalASTSource: mmap'ed memory buffers";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor:
 | |
|       str = "Preprocessor: malloc'ed memory";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_PreprocessingRecord:
 | |
|       str = "Preprocessor: PreprocessingRecord";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_DataStructures:
 | |
|       str = "SourceManager: data structures and tables";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch:
 | |
|       str = "Preprocessor: header search tables";
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return str;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXTUResourceUsage clang_getCXTUResourceUsage(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     CXTUResourceUsage usage = { (void*) nullptr, 0, nullptr };
 | |
|     return usage;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   std::unique_ptr<MemUsageEntries> entries(new MemUsageEntries());
 | |
|   ASTContext &astContext = astUnit->getASTContext();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is used by AST nodes and types?
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_AST,
 | |
|     (unsigned long) astContext.getASTAllocatedMemory());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // How much memory is used by identifiers?
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_Identifiers,
 | |
|     (unsigned long) astContext.Idents.getAllocator().getTotalMemory());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // How much memory is used for selectors?
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_Selectors,
 | |
|     (unsigned long) astContext.Selectors.getTotalMemory());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is used by ASTContext's side tables?
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_AST_SideTables,
 | |
|     (unsigned long) astContext.getSideTableAllocatedMemory());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is used for caching global code completion results?
 | |
|   unsigned long completionBytes = 0;
 | |
|   if (GlobalCodeCompletionAllocator *completionAllocator =
 | |
|       astUnit->getCachedCompletionAllocator().get()) {
 | |
|     completionBytes = completionAllocator->getTotalMemory();
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_GlobalCompletionResults,
 | |
|                                completionBytes);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is being used by SourceManager's content cache?
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|           CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManagerContentCache,
 | |
|           (unsigned long) astContext.getSourceManager().getContentCacheSize());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is being used by the MemoryBuffer's in SourceManager?
 | |
|   const SourceManager::MemoryBufferSizes &srcBufs =
 | |
|     astUnit->getSourceManager().getMemoryBufferSizes();
 | |
|   
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_Malloc,
 | |
|                                (unsigned long) srcBufs.malloc_bytes);
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_MMap,
 | |
|                                (unsigned long) srcBufs.mmap_bytes);
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_DataStructures,
 | |
|                                (unsigned long) astContext.getSourceManager()
 | |
|                                 .getDataStructureSizes());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is being used by the ExternalASTSource?
 | |
|   if (ExternalASTSource *esrc = astContext.getExternalSource()) {
 | |
|     const ExternalASTSource::MemoryBufferSizes &sizes =
 | |
|       esrc->getMemoryBufferSizes();
 | |
|     
 | |
|     createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|       CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_Malloc,
 | |
|                                  (unsigned long) sizes.malloc_bytes);
 | |
|     createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|       CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_MMap,
 | |
|                                  (unsigned long) sizes.mmap_bytes);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   // How much memory is being used by the Preprocessor?
 | |
|   Preprocessor &pp = astUnit->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor,
 | |
|                                pp.getTotalMemory());
 | |
|   
 | |
|   if (PreprocessingRecord *pRec = pp.getPreprocessingRecord()) {
 | |
|     createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                  CXTUResourceUsage_PreprocessingRecord,
 | |
|                                  pRec->getTotalMemory());    
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   
 | |
|   createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries,
 | |
|                                CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch,
 | |
|                                pp.getHeaderSearchInfo().getTotalMemory());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXTUResourceUsage usage = { (void*) entries.get(),
 | |
|                             (unsigned) entries->size(),
 | |
|                             !entries->empty() ? &(*entries)[0] : nullptr };
 | |
|   (void)entries.release();
 | |
|   return usage;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage(CXTUResourceUsage usage) {
 | |
|   if (usage.data)
 | |
|     delete (MemUsageEntries*) usage.data;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRangeList *clang_getSkippedRanges(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile file) {
 | |
|   CXSourceRangeList *skipped = new CXSourceRangeList;
 | |
|   skipped->count = 0;
 | |
|   skipped->ranges = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return skipped;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!file)
 | |
|     return skipped;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   PreprocessingRecord *ppRec = astUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord();
 | |
|   if (!ppRec)
 | |
|     return skipped;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = astUnit->getASTContext();
 | |
|   SourceManager &sm = Ctx.getSourceManager();
 | |
|   FileEntry *fileEntry = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file);
 | |
|   FileID wantedFileID = sm.translateFile(fileEntry);
 | |
|   bool isMainFile = wantedFileID == sm.getMainFileID();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const std::vector<SourceRange> &SkippedRanges = ppRec->getSkippedRanges();
 | |
|   std::vector<SourceRange> wantedRanges;
 | |
|   for (std::vector<SourceRange>::const_iterator i = SkippedRanges.begin(), ei = SkippedRanges.end();
 | |
|        i != ei; ++i) {
 | |
|     if (sm.getFileID(i->getBegin()) == wantedFileID || sm.getFileID(i->getEnd()) == wantedFileID)
 | |
|       wantedRanges.push_back(*i);
 | |
|     else if (isMainFile && (astUnit->isInPreambleFileID(i->getBegin()) || astUnit->isInPreambleFileID(i->getEnd())))
 | |
|       wantedRanges.push_back(*i);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   skipped->count = wantedRanges.size();
 | |
|   skipped->ranges = new CXSourceRange[skipped->count];
 | |
|   for (unsigned i = 0, ei = skipped->count; i != ei; ++i)
 | |
|     skipped->ranges[i] = cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, wantedRanges[i]);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return skipped;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXSourceRangeList *clang_getAllSkippedRanges(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   CXSourceRangeList *skipped = new CXSourceRangeList;
 | |
|   skipped->count = 0;
 | |
|   skipped->ranges = nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) {
 | |
|     LOG_BAD_TU(TU);
 | |
|     return skipped;
 | |
|   }
 | |
|     
 | |
|   ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   PreprocessingRecord *ppRec = astUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord();
 | |
|   if (!ppRec)
 | |
|     return skipped;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTContext &Ctx = astUnit->getASTContext();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   const std::vector<SourceRange> &SkippedRanges = ppRec->getSkippedRanges();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   skipped->count = SkippedRanges.size();
 | |
|   skipped->ranges = new CXSourceRange[skipped->count];
 | |
|   for (unsigned i = 0, ei = skipped->count; i != ei; ++i)
 | |
|     skipped->ranges[i] = cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, SkippedRanges[i]);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return skipped;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang_disposeSourceRangeList(CXSourceRangeList *ranges) {
 | |
|   if (ranges) {
 | |
|     delete[] ranges->ranges;
 | |
|     delete ranges;
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang::PrintLibclangResourceUsage(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   CXTUResourceUsage Usage = clang_getCXTUResourceUsage(TU);
 | |
|   for (unsigned I = 0; I != Usage.numEntries; ++I)
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "  %s: %lu\n", 
 | |
|             clang_getTUResourceUsageName(Usage.entries[I].kind),
 | |
|             Usage.entries[I].amount);
 | |
|   
 | |
|   clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage(Usage);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| // Misc. utility functions.
 | |
| //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
 | |
| 
 | |
| /// Default to using our desired 8 MB stack size on "safety" threads.
 | |
| static unsigned SafetyStackThreadSize = DesiredStackSize;
 | |
| 
 | |
| namespace clang {
 | |
| 
 | |
| bool RunSafely(llvm::CrashRecoveryContext &CRC, llvm::function_ref<void()> Fn,
 | |
|                unsigned Size) {
 | |
|   if (!Size)
 | |
|     Size = GetSafetyThreadStackSize();
 | |
|   if (Size && !getenv("LIBCLANG_NOTHREADS"))
 | |
|     return CRC.RunSafelyOnThread(Fn, Size);
 | |
|   return CRC.RunSafely(Fn);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| unsigned GetSafetyThreadStackSize() {
 | |
|   return SafetyStackThreadSize;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void SetSafetyThreadStackSize(unsigned Value) {
 | |
|   SafetyStackThreadSize = Value;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void clang::setThreadBackgroundPriority() {
 | |
|   if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_DISABLE"))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if LLVM_ENABLE_THREADS
 | |
|   llvm::set_thread_priority(llvm::ThreadPriority::Background);
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void cxindex::printDiagsToStderr(ASTUnit *Unit) {
 | |
|   if (!Unit)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (ASTUnit::stored_diag_iterator D = Unit->stored_diag_begin(), 
 | |
|                                   DEnd = Unit->stored_diag_end();
 | |
|        D != DEnd; ++D) {
 | |
|     CXStoredDiagnostic Diag(*D, Unit->getLangOpts());
 | |
|     CXString Msg = clang_formatDiagnostic(&Diag,
 | |
|                                 clang_defaultDiagnosticDisplayOptions());
 | |
|     fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", clang_getCString(Msg));
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(Msg);
 | |
|   }
 | |
| #ifdef _WIN32
 | |
|   // On Windows, force a flush, since there may be multiple copies of
 | |
|   // stderr and stdout in the file system, all with different buffers
 | |
|   // but writing to the same device.
 | |
|   fflush(stderr);
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| MacroInfo *cxindex::getMacroInfo(const IdentifierInfo &II,
 | |
|                                  SourceLocation MacroDefLoc,
 | |
|                                  CXTranslationUnit TU){
 | |
|   if (MacroDefLoc.isInvalid() || !TU)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   if (!II.hadMacroDefinition())
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   MacroDirective *MD = PP.getLocalMacroDirectiveHistory(&II);
 | |
|   if (MD) {
 | |
|     for (MacroDirective::DefInfo
 | |
|            Def = MD->getDefinition(); Def; Def = Def.getPreviousDefinition()) {
 | |
|       if (MacroDefLoc == Def.getMacroInfo()->getDefinitionLoc())
 | |
|         return Def.getMacroInfo();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return nullptr;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const MacroInfo *cxindex::getMacroInfo(const MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef,
 | |
|                                        CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (!MacroDef || !TU)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   const IdentifierInfo *II = MacroDef->getName();
 | |
|   if (!II)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return getMacroInfo(*II, MacroDef->getLocation(), TU);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| MacroDefinitionRecord *
 | |
| cxindex::checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(const MacroInfo *MI, const Token &Tok,
 | |
|                                         CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (!MI || !TU)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   if (Tok.isNot(tok::raw_identifier))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (MI->getNumTokens() == 0)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   SourceRange DefRange(MI->getReplacementToken(0).getLocation(),
 | |
|                        MI->getDefinitionEndLoc());
 | |
|   ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Check that the token is inside the definition and not its argument list.
 | |
|   SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager();
 | |
|   if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(Tok.getLocation(), DefRange.getBegin()))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(DefRange.getEnd(), Tok.getLocation()))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   PreprocessingRecord *PPRec = PP.getPreprocessingRecord();
 | |
|   if (!PPRec)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   IdentifierInfo &II = PP.getIdentifierTable().get(Tok.getRawIdentifier());
 | |
|   if (!II.hadMacroDefinition())
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   // Check that the identifier is not one of the macro arguments.
 | |
|   if (std::find(MI->param_begin(), MI->param_end(), &II) != MI->param_end())
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   MacroDirective *InnerMD = PP.getLocalMacroDirectiveHistory(&II);
 | |
|   if (!InnerMD)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return PPRec->findMacroDefinition(InnerMD->getMacroInfo());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| MacroDefinitionRecord *
 | |
| cxindex::checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(const MacroInfo *MI, SourceLocation Loc,
 | |
|                                         CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (Loc.isInvalid() || !MI || !TU)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (MI->getNumTokens() == 0)
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU);
 | |
|   Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor();
 | |
|   if (!PP.getPreprocessingRecord())
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
|   Loc = Unit->getSourceManager().getSpellingLoc(Loc);
 | |
|   Token Tok;
 | |
|   if (PP.getRawToken(Loc, Tok))
 | |
|     return nullptr;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Tok, TU);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| CXString clang_getClangVersion() {
 | |
|   return cxstring::createDup(getClangFullVersion());
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXTranslationUnit TU) {
 | |
|   if (TU) {
 | |
|     if (ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)) {
 | |
|       LogOS << '<' << Unit->getMainFileName() << '>';
 | |
|       if (Unit->isMainFileAST())
 | |
|         LogOS << " (" << Unit->getASTFileName() << ')';
 | |
|       return *this;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   } else {
 | |
|     LogOS << "<NULL TU>";
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(const FileEntry *FE) {
 | |
|   *this << FE->getName();
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXCursor cursor) {
 | |
|   CXString cursorName = clang_getCursorDisplayName(cursor);
 | |
|   *this << cursorName << "@" << clang_getCursorLocation(cursor);
 | |
|   clang_disposeString(cursorName);
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXSourceLocation Loc) {
 | |
|   CXFile File;
 | |
|   unsigned Line, Column;
 | |
|   clang_getFileLocation(Loc, &File, &Line, &Column, nullptr);
 | |
|   CXString FileName = clang_getFileName(File);
 | |
|   *this << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d)", clang_getCString(FileName), Line, Column);
 | |
|   clang_disposeString(FileName);
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXSourceRange range) {
 | |
|   CXSourceLocation BLoc = clang_getRangeStart(range);
 | |
|   CXSourceLocation ELoc = clang_getRangeEnd(range);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXFile BFile;
 | |
|   unsigned BLine, BColumn;
 | |
|   clang_getFileLocation(BLoc, &BFile, &BLine, &BColumn, nullptr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXFile EFile;
 | |
|   unsigned ELine, EColumn;
 | |
|   clang_getFileLocation(ELoc, &EFile, &ELine, &EColumn, nullptr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   CXString BFileName = clang_getFileName(BFile);
 | |
|   if (BFile == EFile) {
 | |
|     *this << llvm::format("[%s %d:%d-%d:%d]", clang_getCString(BFileName),
 | |
|                          BLine, BColumn, ELine, EColumn);
 | |
|   } else {
 | |
|     CXString EFileName = clang_getFileName(EFile);
 | |
|     *this << llvm::format("[%s:%d:%d - ", clang_getCString(BFileName),
 | |
|                           BLine, BColumn)
 | |
|           << llvm::format("%s:%d:%d]", clang_getCString(EFileName),
 | |
|                           ELine, EColumn);
 | |
|     clang_disposeString(EFileName);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   clang_disposeString(BFileName);
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXString Str) {
 | |
|   *this << clang_getCString(Str);
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(const llvm::format_object_base &Fmt) {
 | |
|   LogOS << Fmt;
 | |
|   return *this;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static llvm::ManagedStatic<std::mutex> LoggingMutex;
 | |
| 
 | |
| cxindex::Logger::~Logger() {
 | |
|   std::lock_guard<std::mutex> L(*LoggingMutex);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   static llvm::TimeRecord sBeginTR = llvm::TimeRecord::getCurrentTime();
 | |
| 
 | |
|   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
 | |
|   OS << "[libclang:" << Name << ':';
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef USE_DARWIN_THREADS
 | |
|   // TODO: Portability.
 | |
|   mach_port_t tid = pthread_mach_thread_np(pthread_self());
 | |
|   OS << tid << ':';
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|   llvm::TimeRecord TR = llvm::TimeRecord::getCurrentTime();
 | |
|   OS << llvm::format("%7.4f] ", TR.getWallTime() - sBeginTR.getWallTime());
 | |
|   OS << Msg << '\n';
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (Trace) {
 | |
|     llvm::sys::PrintStackTrace(OS);
 | |
|     OS << "--------------------------------------------------\n";
 | |
|   }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef CLANG_TOOL_EXTRA_BUILD
 | |
| // This anchor is used to force the linker to link the clang-tidy plugin.
 | |
| extern volatile int ClangTidyPluginAnchorSource;
 | |
| static int LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED ClangTidyPluginAnchorDestination =
 | |
|     ClangTidyPluginAnchorSource;
 | |
| 
 | |
| // This anchor is used to force the linker to link the clang-include-fixer
 | |
| // plugin.
 | |
| extern volatile int ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorSource;
 | |
| static int LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorDestination =
 | |
|     ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorSource;
 | |
| #endif
 |